blob: 398ce872fe2196b9a1bad448e3a71c69ec5bd24a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua3ecbd92012-12-28 15:04:05 +01007 2012/12/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100828.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200838.3. Advanced logging options
848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
858.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
888.4. Timing events
898.5. Session state at disconnection
908.6. Non-printable characters
918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
938.9. Examples of logs
94
959. Statistics and monitoring
969.1. CSV format
979.2. Unix Socket commands
98
99
1001. Quick reminder about HTTP
101----------------------------
102
103When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
104fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
105on almost anything found in the contents.
106
107However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
108formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
109correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
110
111
1121.1. The HTTP transaction model
113-------------------------------
114
115The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100116to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
118connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
119will involve a new connection :
120
121 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
122
123In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
124establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
125by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
126length.
127
128Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
129to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
130however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
131response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
132header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
133
134 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
135
136Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
137power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
138but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200139a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140
141A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
142keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
143second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
144page :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
149latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
150correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
151the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100152server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200154By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
155connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
156everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
157established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
158sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
159while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
160another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
161sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
162http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
163mode.
164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
1661.2. HTTP request
167-----------------
168
169First, let's consider this HTTP request :
170
171 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100172 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
174 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
175 3 User-agent: my small browser
176 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
177 5 Accept: image/png
178
179
1801.2.1. The Request line
181-----------------------
182
183Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
184
185 - a METHOD : GET
186 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
187 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
188
189All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
190which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
191followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
192is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
193desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
194the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
195
196The URI itself can have several forms :
197
198 - A "relative URI" :
199
200 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201
202 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
203 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
204
205 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
206
207 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
210 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
211 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
212 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
213 must accept this form too.
214
215 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
216 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
217 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
220 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
221 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
222 other protocols too.
223
224In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
225mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
226on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
227It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
228specific to the language, framework or application in use.
229
230
2311.2.2. The request headers
232--------------------------
233
234The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
235beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
236an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
237Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
238values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
239encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
240the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
241define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
242
243Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
244their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
245"Connection:" header).
246
247The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
248that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
249is one valid form of empty line.
250
251Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
252headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
253about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
254application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
255
256Important note:
257 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
258 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
259 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
260 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
261
262
2631.3. HTTP response
264------------------
265
266An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
267messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
268
269 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100270 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
272 2 Content-length: 350
273 3 Content-Type: text/html
274
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200275As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
276codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
277response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100278continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
279the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
280following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
281sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
282(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
283correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
284such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
285state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
286over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
287if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
288information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.3.1. The Response line
292------------------------
293
294Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
295
296 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
297 - a status code : 200
298 - a reason : OK
299
300The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
303 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
304 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
305 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
306
307Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100308"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
310messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
311or "Authentication Required".
312
313Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
314
315 Code When / reason
316 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
317 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
320 400 for an invalid or too large request
321 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
322 accessing the stats page)
323 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
324 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
325 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
326 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
327 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
328 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
329 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
330 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
331 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
332
333The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3344.2).
335
336
3371.3.2. The response headers
338---------------------------
339
340Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
341the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
342details.
343
344
3452. Configuring HAProxy
346----------------------
347
3482.1. Configuration file format
349------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200350
351HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
352
353 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
354 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
355 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
356 "frontend" and "backend".
357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
359referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
360delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100361preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100362escaped by doubling them.
363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
3652.2. Time format
366----------------
367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100368Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
370otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
371numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
372for every keyword. Supported units are :
373
374 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
375 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
376 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
377 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
378 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
379 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
380
381
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003822.3. Examples
383-------------
384
385 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
386 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
387 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
388 global
389 daemon
390 maxconn 256
391
392 defaults
393 mode http
394 timeout connect 5000ms
395 timeout client 50000ms
396 timeout server 50000ms
397
398 frontend http-in
399 bind *:80
400 default_backend servers
401
402 backend servers
403 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
404
405
406 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
407 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
408 global
409 daemon
410 maxconn 256
411
412 defaults
413 mode http
414 timeout connect 5000ms
415 timeout client 50000ms
416 timeout server 50000ms
417
418 listen http-in
419 bind *:80
420 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
421
422
423Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
424
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100425 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200426
427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200429--------------------
430
431Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
432are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
433of them have command-line equivalents.
434
435The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
436
437 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200438 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200440 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - daemon
442 - gid
443 - group
444 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100445 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200446 - nbproc
447 - pidfile
448 - uid
449 - ulimit-n
450 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200451 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200452 - node
453 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100454 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100455
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 * Performance tuning
457 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200458 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100459 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100460 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100461 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200462 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 - noepoll
464 - nokqueue
465 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100466 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200467 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200468 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200469 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100470 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100471 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200472 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100473 - tune.maxaccept
474 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200475 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200476 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100477 - tune.rcvbuf.client
478 - tune.rcvbuf.server
479 - tune.sndbuf.client
480 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100481 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100482 - tune.ssl.lifetime
483 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100484 - tune.zlib.memlevel
485 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200487 * Debugging
488 - debug
489 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200490
491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004923.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493------------------------------------
494
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200495ca-base <dir>
496 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200497 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
498 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500chroot <jail dir>
501 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
502 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
503 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
504 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
505 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
506 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100507
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100508cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
509 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
510 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
511 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
512 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
513 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
514 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
515 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
516 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
517 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
518 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
519 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
520 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
521 they overlap.
522
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523crt-base <dir>
524 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
525 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
526 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
527
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200528daemon
529 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
530 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
531 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
532
533gid <number>
534 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
535 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
536 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100537 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
538 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541group <group name>
542 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
543 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100544
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200545log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
547 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100548 configured with "log global".
549
550 <address> can be one of:
551
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100552 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100553 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
554 port).
555
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100556 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
557 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
558 port).
559
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100560 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
561 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
562 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
563 writeable).
564
565 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200566
567 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
568 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
569 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
570
571 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200572 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
573 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
574 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
575 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
576 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
577 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200579 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100581log-send-hostname [<string>]
582 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
583 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
584 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
585 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
586 the logs.
587
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000588log-tag <string>
589 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
590 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
591 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
592 running on the same host.
593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594nbproc <number>
595 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
596 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
597 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
598 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
599 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
600
601pidfile <pidfile>
602 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
603 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
604 starting the process. See also "daemon".
605
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100606stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200607 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
608 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
609 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
610 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
611 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
612 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
613 the number of processes used.
614
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200615stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
616 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
617 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
618 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
619 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200620
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200621 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
622 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
623 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200624
625stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
626 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
627 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100628 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200629
630stats maxconn <connections>
631 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
632 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634uid <number>
635 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
636 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
637 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
638 one. See also "gid" and "user".
639
640ulimit-n <number>
641 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
642 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
643 option.
644
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100645unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
646 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
647
648 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
649 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
650 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
651 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
652 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
653 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
654 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
655 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
656 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
657 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
658
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659user <user name>
660 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
661 See also "uid" and "group".
662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200663node <name>
664 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
665
666 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
667 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
668 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
669 traffic.
670
671description <text>
672 Add a text that describes the instance.
673
674 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
675 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
676 "<" and ">" characters.
677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680-----------------------
681
682maxconn <number>
683 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
684 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
685 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
686 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
687
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200688maxconnrate <number>
689 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
690 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
691 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
692 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
693 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
694 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
695 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
696 fairness.
697
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100698maxcomprate <number>
699 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
700 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
701 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
702 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
703 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
704 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
705 default value.
706
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100707maxcompcpuusage <number>
708 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
709 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
710 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
711 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
712 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
713 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
714 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
715 process down and from introducing high latencies.
716
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100717maxpipes <number>
718 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
719 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
720 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
721 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
722 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
723 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
724
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200725maxsslconn <number>
726 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
727 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
728 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
729 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
730 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
731 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
732 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
733
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100734maxzlibmem <number>
735 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
736 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
737 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100738 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
739 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
740 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742noepoll
743 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
744 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100745 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746
747nokqueue
748 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
749 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
750 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
751
752nopoll
753 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
754 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100755 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100758nosplice
759 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
760 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
761 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100762 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100763 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
764 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
765 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
766 "option splice-response".
767
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200768spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
769 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
770 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
771 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
772 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
773 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
774
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200775tune.bufsize <number>
776 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
777 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
778 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
779 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
780 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
781 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
782 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
783 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400784 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
785 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
786 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200787
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200788tune.chksize <number>
789 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
790 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
791 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
792 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
793 checks whenever possible.
794
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100795tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
796 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
797 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
798 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
799 this value. The default value is 1.
800
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100801tune.http.cookielen <number>
802 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
803 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
804 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
805 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
806 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
807 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
808 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
809 to change this value.
810
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200811tune.http.maxhdr <number>
812 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
813 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
814 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
815 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
816 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
817 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
818 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
819 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
820 limit too high.
821
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100822tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100823 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
824 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
825 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
826 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
827 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
828 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
829 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
830 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
831 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
832 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100833
834tune.maxpollevents <number>
835 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
836 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
837 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
838 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
839 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
840
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200841tune.maxrewrite <number>
842 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
843 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
844 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
845 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
846 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
847 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
848 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
849 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
850 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
851 bufsize.
852
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200853tune.pipesize <number>
854 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
855 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
856 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
857 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
858 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
859 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
860
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100861tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
862tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
863 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
864 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
865 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
866 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
867 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
868 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
869 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
870
871tune.sndbuf.client <number>
872tune.sndbuf.server <number>
873 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
874 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
876 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
880 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
881 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
882 notifying haproxy again.
883
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100884tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100885 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
886 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
887 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
888 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
889 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
890 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
891 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
892 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
893 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100894 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
895 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100896
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100897tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
898 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
899 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
900 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
901 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
902 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
903 being used for too long.
904
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100905tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
906 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
907 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
908 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
909 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
910 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
911 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
912 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
913 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
914 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
915 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
916 best value.
917
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100918tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
919 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
920 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
921 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
922 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
923 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
924
925tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
926 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
927 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
928 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
929 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009313.3. Debugging
932--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200933
934debug
935 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
936 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
937 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
938 system startup.
939
940quiet
941 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
942 line argument "-q".
943
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009453.4. Userlists
946--------------
947It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
948http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
949it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
950
951userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100952 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100953 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
954
955group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100956 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100957 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
958 proceeded by "users" keyword.
959
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100960user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
961 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100962 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
963 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100964 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
965 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100966 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
967 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
968
969
970 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100971 userlist L1
972 group G1 users tiger,scott
973 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100974
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100975 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
976 user scott insecure-password elgato
977 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100978
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100979 userlist L2
980 group G1
981 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100982
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100983 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
984 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
985 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100986
987 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200988
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200989
9903.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200991----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200992It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
993haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
994pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
995identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
996or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
997Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
998known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
999the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1000process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1001during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1002tables.
1003
1004peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001005 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001006 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1007
1008peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1009 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1010 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1011 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1012 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1013 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1014 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1015
1016 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1017 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1018
1019 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1020 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1021 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1022 across all peers.
1023
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001024 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001025 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001026 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1027 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1028 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001029
1030 backend mybackend
1031 mode tcp
1032 balance roundrobin
1033 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1034 stick on src
1035
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001036 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1037 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001038
1039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010404. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001041----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001042
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1044 - defaults <name>
1045 - frontend <name>
1046 - backend <name>
1047 - listen <name>
1048
1049A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1050its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1051section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001052section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053
1054A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1055connections.
1056
1057A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1058to forward incoming connections.
1059
1060A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1061parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1062
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001063All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1064'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1065case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1066
1067Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1068logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1069proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1070However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1071name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1072
1073Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1074and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001075bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001076protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1077modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1078arbitrary criteria.
1079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010814.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1082--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001084The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1085limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1086they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1087limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001088marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001089option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001090and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1091with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1092specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001093
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001094
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001095 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1096------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1097acl - X X X
1098appsession - - X X
1099backlog X X X -
1100balance X - X X
1101bind - X X -
1102bind-process X X X X
1103block - X X X
1104capture cookie - X X -
1105capture request header - X X -
1106capture response header - X X -
1107clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001108compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1110cookie X - X X
1111default-server X - X X
1112default_backend X X X -
1113description - X X X
1114disabled X X X X
1115dispatch - - X X
1116enabled X X X X
1117errorfile X X X X
1118errorloc X X X X
1119errorloc302 X X X X
1120-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1121errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001122force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001123fullconn X - X X
1124grace X X X X
1125hash-type X - X X
1126http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001127http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001128http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001129http-request - X X X
1130id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001131ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001132log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001133maxconn X X X -
1134mode X X X X
1135monitor fail - X X -
1136monitor-net X X X -
1137monitor-uri X X X -
1138option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1139option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1140option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1141option allbackups (*) X - X X
1142option checkcache (*) X - X X
1143option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1144option contstats (*) X X X -
1145option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1146option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1147option forceclose (*) X X X X
1148-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1149option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001150option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001151option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001152option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1153option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1154option httpchk X - X X
1155option httpclose (*) X X X X
1156option httplog X X X X
1157option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001158option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09001159option lb-agent-chk X - X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001160option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001161option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1162option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1163option logasap (*) X X X -
1164option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001165option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001166option nolinger (*) X X X X
1167option originalto X X X X
1168option persist (*) X - X X
1169option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001170option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001171option smtpchk X - X X
1172option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1173option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1174option splice-request (*) X X X X
1175option splice-response (*) X X X X
1176option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1177option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1178-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1179option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1180option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1181option tcpka X X X X
1182option tcplog X X X X
1183option transparent (*) X - X X
1184persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1185rate-limit sessions X X X -
1186redirect - X X X
1187redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1188redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1189reqadd - X X X
1190reqallow - X X X
1191reqdel - X X X
1192reqdeny - X X X
1193reqiallow - X X X
1194reqidel - X X X
1195reqideny - X X X
1196reqipass - X X X
1197reqirep - X X X
1198reqisetbe - X X X
1199reqitarpit - X X X
1200reqpass - X X X
1201reqrep - X X X
1202-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1203reqsetbe - X X X
1204reqtarpit - X X X
1205retries X - X X
1206rspadd - X X X
1207rspdel - X X X
1208rspdeny - X X X
1209rspidel - X X X
1210rspideny - X X X
1211rspirep - X X X
1212rsprep - X X X
1213server - - X X
1214source X - X X
1215srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001216stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001217stats auth X - X X
1218stats enable X - X X
1219stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001220stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001221stats realm X - X X
1222stats refresh X - X X
1223stats scope X - X X
1224stats show-desc X - X X
1225stats show-legends X - X X
1226stats show-node X - X X
1227stats uri X - X X
1228-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1229stick match - - X X
1230stick on - - X X
1231stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001232stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001233stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001234tcp-request connection - X X -
1235tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001236tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001237tcp-response content - - X X
1238tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001239timeout check X - X X
1240timeout client X X X -
1241timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1242timeout connect X - X X
1243timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1244timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1245timeout http-request X X X X
1246timeout queue X - X X
1247timeout server X - X X
1248timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1249timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001250timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001251transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001252unique-id-format X X X -
1253unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001254use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001255use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1257 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1261---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
1263This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1264
1265
1266acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1267 Declare or complete an access list.
1268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1269 no | yes | yes | yes
1270 Example:
1271 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1272 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1273 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001275 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
1277
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001278appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1279 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001280 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1282 no | no | yes | yes
1283 Arguments :
1284 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1285 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1286
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001287 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001288 checked in each cookie value.
1289
1290 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1291 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1292 milliseconds.
1293
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001294 request-learn
1295 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1296 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1297 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1298 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1299 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1300 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1301
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001302 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1303 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1304 data following this prefix.
1305
1306 Example :
1307 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1308
1309 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1310 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1311
1312 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1313 2 modes are currently supported :
1314 - path-parameters :
1315 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1316 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1317 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1318 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1319 - query-string :
1320 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1321 query string.
1322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1324 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1325 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1326 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001327 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1328 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1329 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001330 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1331 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1332
1333 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1334
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001335 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1336 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1337 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001339 Example :
1340 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1341
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001342 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1343 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344
1345
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001346backlog <conns>
1347 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1349 yes | yes | yes | no
1350 Arguments :
1351 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1352 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001353 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001354
1355 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1356 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1357 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1358 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1359 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1360 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1361 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1362 backlog parameter.
1363
1364 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1365 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1366 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1367
1368 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1369
1370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001371balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001372balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001373 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1375 yes | no | yes | yes
1376 Arguments :
1377 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1378 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1379 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1380 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1381
1382 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1383 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1384 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1385 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001386 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1387 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1388 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1389 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1390 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1391 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1392 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1393 it, so that you don't worry.
1394
1395 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1396 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1397 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1398 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1399 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1400 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1401 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1402 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001403
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001404 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1405 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1406 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1407 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1408 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1409 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1410 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1411 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1412
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001413 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1414 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1415 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1416 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001417 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001418 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1419 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1420 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1421 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1422 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001423 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1424 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1425 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1426 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1427 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1428 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001430 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1431 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1432 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1433 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1434 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1435 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1436 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1437 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001438 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001439 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001440 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1441 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1442 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001443
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001444 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1445 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1446 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1447 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1448 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1449 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1450 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1451 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1452 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1453 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1454 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1455 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001457 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001458 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1459 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1460 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1461 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1462 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1463 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1464 URIs start with a leading "/".
1465
1466 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1467 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1468 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1469 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001471 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001472 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1473
1474 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001475 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1476 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1477 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1478 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1479 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1480 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1481 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1482 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1483 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1484 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1485 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1486 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1487 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1488 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1489 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1490 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1491 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1492 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1493 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001494
1495 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1496 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1497 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1498 server will receive the request.
1499
1500 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1501 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1502 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1503 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1504 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001505 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1506 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1507 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001509 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1510 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1511 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1512 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1513 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001515 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001516 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1517 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1518 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1519
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001520 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1521 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1522 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1523
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001524 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001525 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001526 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1527 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1528 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1529 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1530 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1531 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001532 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001533 used instead.
1534
1535 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1536 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1537 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1538 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1539
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001540 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1541 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1542 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1543
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001544 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001545
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001546 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001547 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1548 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001549
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001550 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001551 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001552
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001553 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1554 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1555 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001556
1557 Examples :
1558 balance roundrobin
1559 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001560 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001561 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1562 balance hdr(host)
1563 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001564
1565 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1566 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001568 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001569 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1570 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1571 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1572 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1573
1574 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1575 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1576 defaults to 16 kB.
1577
1578 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1579 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1580
1581 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1582 Round Robin.
1583
1584 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1585 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1586 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1587 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1588
1589 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1590
1591 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001592 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001593 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1594 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1595 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001596
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001597 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1598 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001599
1600
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001601bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1602bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001603 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1605 no | yes | yes | no
1606 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001607 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1608 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1609 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1610 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001611 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001612
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001613 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1614 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001615 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1616 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1617 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001618 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1619 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1620 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1621 the range.
1622
1623 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1624 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1625 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1626 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1627 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1628 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1629 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001630 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001631 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001633 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1634 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1635 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1636 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1637 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1638 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1639 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1640 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1641
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001642 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1643 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1644 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1645 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001646
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001647 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1648 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1649 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1650 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1651 in a frontend.
1652
1653 Example :
1654 listen http_proxy
1655 bind :80,:443
1656 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001657 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001658
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001659 listen http_https_proxy
1660 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001661 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001662
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001663 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001664 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001665
1666
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001667bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001668 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1670 yes | yes | yes | yes
1671 Arguments :
1672 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1673 may be used to override a default value.
1674
1675 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1676 option may be combined with other numbers.
1677
1678 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1679 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1680 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1681 missing from all processes.
1682
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001683 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1684 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1685 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1686 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1687 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001688
1689 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1690 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1691 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1692 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1693 and 'even' instances.
1694
1695 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1696 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1697 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1698 32.
1699
1700 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1701 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1702
1703 Example :
1704 listen app_ip1
1705 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001706 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001707
1708 listen app_ip2
1709 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001710 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001711
1712 listen management
1713 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001714 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001715
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001716 listen management
1717 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1718 bind-process 1-4
1719
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001720 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1721
1722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001723block { if | unless } <condition>
1724 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1726 no | yes | yes | yes
1727
1728 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1729 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001730 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001731 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001732 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1733 "block" statements per instance.
1734
1735 Example:
1736 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1737 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1738 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1739 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001741 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001742
1743
1744capture cookie <name> len <length>
1745 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1747 no | yes | yes | no
1748 Arguments :
1749 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1750 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1751 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1752 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1753 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1754
1755 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1756 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1757 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1758 right if it exceeds <length>.
1759
1760 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1761 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1762 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1763 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1764
1765 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1766 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1767 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1768
1769 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1770 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1771 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001772 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1773 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1774 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001775
1776 Example:
1777 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1778
1779 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001780 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
1782
1783capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001784 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1786 no | yes | yes | no
1787 Arguments :
1788 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001789 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1791 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1792 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1793
1794 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1795 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1796 it exceeds <length>.
1797
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001798 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001799 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1800 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001801 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1802 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1803 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1804 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001805 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001806 environments to find where the request came from.
1807
1808 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1809 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1810 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1811 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001812
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001813 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1814 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1815 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1816 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1817 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818
1819 Example:
1820 capture request header Host len 15
1821 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1822 capture request header Referrer len 15
1823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001824 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825 about logging.
1826
1827
1828capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001829 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1831 no | yes | yes | no
1832 Arguments :
1833 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001834 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001835 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1836 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1837 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1838
1839 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1840 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1841 it exceeds <length>.
1842
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001843 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1845 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1846 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001847 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1848 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1849 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1850 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001852 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1853 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1854 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1855 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1856 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
1858 Example:
1859 capture response header Content-length len 9
1860 capture response header Location len 15
1861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001862 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863 about logging.
1864
1865
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001866clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1869 yes | yes | yes | no
1870 Arguments :
1871 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1872 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1873 as explained at the top of this document.
1874
1875 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1876 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1877 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1878 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1879 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1880 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1881 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1882 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001883 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1885 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1886
1887 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1888 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1889 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1890 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1891 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1892 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1893
1894 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1895 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1896
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001897 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1898 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001900compression algo <algorithm> ...
1901compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001902compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001903 Enable HTTP compression.
1904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1905 yes | yes | yes | yes
1906 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001907 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1908 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1909 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1910
1911 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001912 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001913 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1914 data.
1915
1916 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1917 support for zlib was built in.
1918
1919 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1920 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1921 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1922 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1923 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1924 in.
1925
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001926 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001927 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001928 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1929 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1930 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1931 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1932 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001933
1934 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1935 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1936 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1937 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1938 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001939 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1940 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1941 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1942 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1943 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1944 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001945
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001946 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001947 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1948 "Accept-Encoding" header
1949 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001950 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001951 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1952 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1953 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1954 "multipart"
1955 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1956 header
1957 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1958 and later
1959 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1960 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001961
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001962 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
1963 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001964
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001965 Examples :
1966 compression algo gzip
1967 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001969contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001970 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1972 yes | no | yes | yes
1973 Arguments :
1974 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1975 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1976 as explained at the top of this document.
1977
1978 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001979 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001980 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1982 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1983 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1984 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1985
1986 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1987 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1988 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1989 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1990 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1991 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1992
1993 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1994 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1995 instead.
1996
1997 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1998 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1999
2000
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002001cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002002 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2003 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002004 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2006 yes | no | yes | yes
2007 Arguments :
2008 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2009 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2010 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2011 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2012 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2013 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2014 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2015 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2016 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2017
2018 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2019 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2020 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2021 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2022 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2023 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2024 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2025 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2026 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2027 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2028 "insert" and "prefix".
2029
2030 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002031 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002032
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002033 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002034 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2035 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2036 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2037 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2038 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2039 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2040 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2041 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2042 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2043 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002044
2045 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2046 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2047 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2048 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2049 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2050 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2051 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2052 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2053 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2054 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002055 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2056 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2057 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002059 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2060 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2061 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002062 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2063 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2064 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2065 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002066 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2067 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2068 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002069
2070 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2071 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2072 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2073 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2074 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2075 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2076 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2077 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2078 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2079
2080 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2081 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2082 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2083 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2084 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2085 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2086 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2087 persistence cookie in the cache.
2088 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2089
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002090 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2091 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2092 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2093 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2094 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2095 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2096 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2097 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2098 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2099 they logout.
2100
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002101 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2102 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2103 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2104 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2105
2106 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2107 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2108 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2109 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2110 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2111 this attribute.
2112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002113 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002114 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002115 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2116 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2117 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2118 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2119 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2120 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002121
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002122 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2123 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2124 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2125 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2126 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2127 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2128 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2129 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2130 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2131 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2132 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2133 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2134 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2135 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2136 the site.
2137
2138 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2139 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2140 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2141 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2142 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2143 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2144 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2145 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2146 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2147 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2148 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2149 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2150 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2151 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2152 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2153 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2156 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2157 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2158 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002160 Examples :
2161 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2162 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2163 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002164 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002166 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002167 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002168
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002170default-server [param*]
2171 Change default options for a server in a backend
2172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2173 yes | no | yes | yes
2174 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002175 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2176 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2177 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2178 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002179
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002180 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002181 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2182
2183 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002184
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002186default_backend <backend>
2187 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2189 yes | yes | yes | no
2190 Arguments :
2191 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2192
2193 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2194 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2195 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2196 will catch all undetermined requests.
2197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198 Example :
2199
2200 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2201 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2202 default_backend dynamic
2203
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002204 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
2207disabled
2208 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2210 yes | yes | yes | yes
2211 Arguments : none
2212
2213 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2214 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2215 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2216 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2217 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2218 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2219 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2220
2221 See also : "enabled"
2222
2223
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002224dispatch <address>:<port>
2225 Set a default server address
2226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2227 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002228 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002229
2230 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2231 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2232 during start-up.
2233
2234 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2235 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2236 possible with normal servers.
2237
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002238 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002239 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2240 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2241 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2242 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2243
2244 See also : "server"
2245
2246
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002247enabled
2248 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2250 yes | yes | yes | yes
2251 Arguments : none
2252
2253 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2254 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2255
2256 See also : "disabled"
2257
2258
2259errorfile <code> <file>
2260 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2262 yes | yes | yes | yes
2263 Arguments :
2264 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002265 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002266
2267 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002268 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002270 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2271 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002272
2273 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2274 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2275 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2276
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002277 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2280 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2281 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2282 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2283
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002284 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2285 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2286 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2287 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2288 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2289 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2290
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002291 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2292 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2293 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002294 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002295 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2296
2297 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2298
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002299 Example :
2300 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2301 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2302 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002304
2305errorloc <code> <url>
2306errorloc302 <code> <url>
2307 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2309 yes | yes | yes | yes
2310 Arguments :
2311 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002312 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002313
2314 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2315 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2316 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2317 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2318 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2319
2320 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2321 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2322 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2323
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002324 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2325
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002326 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2327 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2328 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2329 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2330 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2331 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2332 request.
2333
2334 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2335
2336
2337errorloc303 <code> <url>
2338 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2340 yes | yes | yes | yes
2341 Arguments :
2342 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2343 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2344
2345 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2346 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2347 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2348 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2349 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2350
2351 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2352 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2353 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2354
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002355 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2356
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002357 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2358 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2359 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2360 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002361 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002362
2363 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2364
2365
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002366force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2367 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2368 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370
2371 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2372 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2373 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2374 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2375 marked down for maintenance operations.
2376
2377 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2378 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2379 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2380 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2381 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2382 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2383 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2384 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2385 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2386
2387 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2388 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2389 is used.
2390
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002391 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002392 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002393
2394
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002395fullconn <conns>
2396 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 yes | no | yes | yes
2399 Arguments :
2400 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2401 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2402
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002403 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002404 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002405 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002406 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2407 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2408 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2409 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2410 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002411 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002412
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002413 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2414 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2415 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2416
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002417 Example :
2418 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2419 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2420 # connections.
2421 backend dynamic
2422 fullconn 10000
2423 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2424 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2425
2426 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2427
2428
2429grace <time>
2430 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002432 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002433 Arguments :
2434 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2435 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2436 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2437
2438 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2439 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002440 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002441 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2442
2443 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2444 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2445 simplify it.
2446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002448hash-type <method>
2449 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | no | yes | yes
2452 Arguments :
2453 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2454 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2455 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2456 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2457 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2458 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2459 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2460 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2461 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2462
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002463 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2464 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2465 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2466 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2467 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2468 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2469 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2470 this value.
2471
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002472 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2473 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2474 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2475 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2476 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2477 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2478 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2479 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2480 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2481 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2482 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2483 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2484 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2485
2486 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2487
2488 See also : "balance", "server"
2489
2490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491http-check disable-on-404
2492 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002494 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495 Arguments : none
2496
2497 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2498 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2499 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2500 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2501 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2502 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2503 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2504 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002505 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2506 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2507 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2508
2509 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2510
2511
2512http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002513 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002515 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002516 Arguments :
2517 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2518 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002519 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002520 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2521 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2522 details on the supported keywords.
2523
2524 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2525 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2526 with the usual backslash ('\').
2527
2528 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2529 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2530 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2531 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2532 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2533
2534 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002535 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002536 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2537 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2538 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2539
2540 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002541 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002542 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2543 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2544 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2545 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2546
2547 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002548 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002549 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2550 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2551 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2552 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2553 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2554 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2555 trace).
2556
2557 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002558 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002559 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2560 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2561 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2562 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2563 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2564 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2565
2566 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2567 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2568 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2569 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2570 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2571 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2572 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2573 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2574
2575 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2576 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2577
2578 Examples :
2579 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002580 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002581
2582 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002583 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002584
2585 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002586 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002587
2588 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002589 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002591 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002592
2593
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002594http-check send-state
2595 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2597 yes | no | yes | yes
2598 Arguments : none
2599
2600 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2601 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2602 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2603 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2604 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2605
2606 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2607 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2608 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2609 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2610 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2611 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2612 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2613 checked in multiple backends.
2614
2615 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2616 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2617
2618 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2619 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2620 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2621 one fails.
2622
2623 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2624 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2625 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2626
2627 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2628 server's queue.
2629
2630 Example of a header received by the application server :
2631 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2632 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2633
2634 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2635
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002636http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002637 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002638 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002639 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2640
2641 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2642 no | yes | yes | yes
2643
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002644 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2645 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2646 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2647 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2648 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002649
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002650 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2651 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2652 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2653
2654 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2655 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2656 are evaluated.
2657
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002658 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2659 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2660 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2661 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2662 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2663 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2664 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2665 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2666 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2667 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2668 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2669
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002670 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2671 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2672 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2673 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2674 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2675
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002676 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2677 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2678 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2679 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2680
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002681 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2682 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2683 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2684 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2685 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2686 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2687 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2688 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2689
2690 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2691 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2692 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2693 external users.
2694
2695 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2696
2697 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2698 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2699 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2700 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002701
2702 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002703 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2704 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2705 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002706
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002707 http-request allow if nagios
2708 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2709 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2710 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002711
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002712 Example:
2713 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002714 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002715
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002716 Example:
2717 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2718 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2719 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2720 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2721 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2722 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2723 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2724 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2725 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2726
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002727 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2728 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002729
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002730http-send-name-header [<header>]
2731 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2732
2733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2734 yes | no | yes | yes
2735
2736 Arguments :
2737
2738 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2739
2740 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2741 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2742 is added with the header string proved.
2743
2744 See also : "server"
2745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002746id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002747 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2749 no | yes | yes | yes
2750 Arguments : none
2751
2752 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2753 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2754 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002755
2756
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002757ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2758 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2760 no | yes | yes | yes
2761
2762 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2763 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2764 and running).
2765
2766 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2767 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2768 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2769 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2770 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2771
2772 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2773 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2774
2775 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2776 "unless" condition is met.
2777
2778 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2779
2780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002781log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002782log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002783no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002784 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2786 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002787
2788 Prefix :
2789 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2790 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2791 prefix does not allow arguments.
2792
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002793 Arguments :
2794 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2795 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2796 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2797 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2798 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2799 parameter.
2800
2801 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2802 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2803
2804 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2805 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2806 standard syslog port).
2807
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002808 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2809 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2810 standard syslog port).
2811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002812 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2813 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2814 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2815 appropriately writeable).
2816
2817 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2818
2819 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2820 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2821 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2822
2823 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2824 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2825 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002826 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2827 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2828 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2829 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2830 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002831
2832 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2833
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002834 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2835 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2836 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002837
2838 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2839 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2840 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2841 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2842
2843 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2844 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002845
2846 Example :
2847 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002848 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2849 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002850
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002851log-format <string>
2852 Allows you to custom a log line.
2853
2854 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2855
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002856
2857maxconn <conns>
2858 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2860 yes | yes | yes | no
2861 Arguments :
2862 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2863 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2864 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2865 closes.
2866
2867 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2868 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2869 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2870 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2871 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2872 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2873 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2874 properly tuned.
2875
2876 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2877 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2878 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2879
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002880 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2881
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002882 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2883
2884
2885mode { tcp|http|health }
2886 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 yes | yes | yes | yes
2889 Arguments :
2890 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2891 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2892 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2893 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2894
2895 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2896 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2897 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2898 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2899 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2900
2901 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002902 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2903 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2904 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2905 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2906 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2907 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2908 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002909
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002910 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2911 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2912 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002913
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002914 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002915 defaults http_instances
2916 mode http
2917
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002918 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002919
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002920
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002921monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002922 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2924 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 Arguments :
2926 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2927 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002928 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2930 backend and its backup.
2931
2932 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2933 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2934 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2935 servers in a list of backends.
2936
2937 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2938 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2939 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2940 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2941 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2942 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2943 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002944 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2945 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002946
2947 Example:
2948 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002949 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2951 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2952 monitor-uri /site_alive
2953 monitor fail if site_dead
2954
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002955 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002956
2957
2958monitor-net <source>
2959 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2961 yes | yes | yes | no
2962 Arguments :
2963 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2964 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2965 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2966 followed by a mask.
2967
2968 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2969 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002970 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002971 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2972
2973 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2974 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2975 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2976 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002977 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2978 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2979 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002980
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002981 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2982 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2983 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2984 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2985 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2986 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002987
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002988 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2989 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002990
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002991 Example :
2992 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2993 frontend www
2994 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2995
2996 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2997
2998
2999monitor-uri <uri>
3000 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3002 yes | yes | yes | no
3003 Arguments :
3004 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3005 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3006
3007 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3008 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3009 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3010 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3011 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3012 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3013 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3014 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3015
3016 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3017 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3018 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3019 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3020 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3021 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3022
3023 Example :
3024 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3025 frontend www
3026 mode http
3027 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3028
3029 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003032option abortonclose
3033no option abortonclose
3034 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3036 yes | no | yes | yes
3037 Arguments : none
3038
3039 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3040 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3041 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3042 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003043 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003044 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3045 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3046 encountered while delivering the response.
3047
3048 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3049 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3050 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3051 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3052 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3053 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003054 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003055 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003056 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003057 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3058 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3059 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3060
3061 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3062 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3063 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3064 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3065 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3066 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3067 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3068 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003069 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003070
3071 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3072 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3073
3074 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3075
3076
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003077option accept-invalid-http-request
3078no option accept-invalid-http-request
3079 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3081 yes | yes | yes | no
3082 Arguments : none
3083
3084 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3085 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3086 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3087 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3088 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3089 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3090 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3091 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003092 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3093 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3094 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3095 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3096 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3097 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003098
3099 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3100 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3101 been confirmed.
3102
3103 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3104 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003105 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3106 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003107 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3108
3109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3111
3112 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3113 stats socket.
3114
3115
3116option accept-invalid-http-response
3117no option accept-invalid-http-response
3118 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3120 yes | no | yes | yes
3121 Arguments : none
3122
3123 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3124 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3125 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3126 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3127 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3128 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3129 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3130 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3131 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3132
3133 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3134 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3135 been confirmed.
3136
3137 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3138 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3139 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3140 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3141
3142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3144
3145 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3146 stats socket.
3147
3148
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003149option allbackups
3150no option allbackups
3151 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3153 yes | no | yes | yes
3154 Arguments : none
3155
3156 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3157 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3158 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3159 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3160 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3161 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3162 order between the backup servers anymore.
3163
3164 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3165 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3166
3167 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3168 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3169
3170
3171option checkcache
3172no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003173 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3175 yes | no | yes | yes
3176 Arguments : none
3177
3178 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3179 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003180 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003181 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3182 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003183 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003184
3185 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003186 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003187 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003188 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3189 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003190 to the client are :
3191 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003192 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003193 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003194 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3195 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3196 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3197 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3198 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3199 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3200 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3201 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3202 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3203 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3204 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3205
3206 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003207 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003208 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003209 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003210 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3211
3212 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3213 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003214 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003215 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3216
3217 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3218 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3219
3220
3221option clitcpka
3222no option clitcpka
3223 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 yes | yes | yes | no
3226 Arguments : none
3227
3228 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3229 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3230 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3231 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3232
3233 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3234 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3235 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3236 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3237
3238 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3239 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3240 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3241 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3242 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3243
3244 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3245
3246 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3247 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3248 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3249
3250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3252
3253 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3254
3255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003256option contstats
3257 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 yes | yes | yes | no
3260 Arguments : none
3261
3262 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3263 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3264 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3265 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3266 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3267 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3268 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3269
3270
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003271option dontlog-normal
3272no option dontlog-normal
3273 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3275 yes | yes | yes | no
3276 Arguments : none
3277
3278 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3279 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3280 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3281 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3282 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3283 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3284 logged.
3285
3286 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3287 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3288 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003290 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003291 logging.
3292
3293
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003294option dontlognull
3295no option dontlognull
3296 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3298 yes | yes | yes | no
3299 Arguments : none
3300
3301 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3302 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3303 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3304 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3305 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3306 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3307 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3308
3309 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3310 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3311 would not be logged.
3312
3313 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3314 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003316 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003317
3318
3319option forceclose
3320no option forceclose
3321 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003323 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003324 Arguments : none
3325
3326 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3327 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3328 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3329 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3330 global session times in the logs.
3331
3332 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003333 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003334 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3335 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3336 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3337 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003338
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003339 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3340 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3341 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3342
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003343 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3344 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3345
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003346 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003347
3348
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003349option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003350 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3352 yes | yes | yes | yes
3353 Arguments :
3354 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3355 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003356 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003357 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003358
3359 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3360 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3361 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3362 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3363 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3364 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3365 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003366 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3367 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3368 possible that the client has already brought one.
3369
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003370 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003371 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003372 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3373 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003374 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3375 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003376
3377 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3378 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3379 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3380 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3381 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3382 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3383 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3384
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003385 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3386 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3387 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3388 are under the control of the end-user.
3389
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003390 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003391 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3392 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003393 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3394 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3395 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003396
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003397 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3398 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3399 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3400 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3401 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003402
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003403 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003404 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3405 frontend www
3406 mode http
3407 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3408
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003409 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3410 backend www
3411 mode http
3412 option forwardfor header X-Client
3413
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003414 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3415 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003416
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003417
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003418option http-no-delay
3419no option http-no-delay
3420 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3422 yes | yes | yes | yes
3423 Arguments : none
3424
3425 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3426 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3427 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3428 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3429 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3430 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3431 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3432 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3433 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3434 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3435 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3436 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3437 affected.
3438
3439 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3440 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3441 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3442 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3443 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3444 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3445 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3446 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3447 latency environments.
3448
3449
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003450option http-pretend-keepalive
3451no option http-pretend-keepalive
3452 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3454 yes | yes | yes | yes
3455 Arguments : none
3456
3457 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3458 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3459 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3460 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3461 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3462 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3463 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3464 consider the response complete.
3465
3466 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3467 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3468 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3469 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3470 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3471 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3472
3473 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3474 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3475 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3476 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3477 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3478 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3479 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3480
3481 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3482 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003483 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003484 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3485 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003486
3487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3489
3490 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3491
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003492
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003493option http-server-close
3494no option http-server-close
3495 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3497 yes | yes | yes | yes
3498 Arguments : none
3499
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003500 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3501 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3502 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3503 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3504 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3505 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3506 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3507 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3508 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3509 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3510 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3511 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003512
3513 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3514 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3515 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3516 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003517 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3518 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003519
3520 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3521 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003522 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3523 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3524 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003525
3526 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3527 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3528
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003529 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3530 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003531
3532
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003533option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003534no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003535 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3537 yes | yes | yes | no
3538 Arguments : none
3539
3540 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3541 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3542 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3543 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3544 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3545 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3546 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3547
3548 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3549 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3550 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3551 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3552 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3553 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3554 request along its whole life.
3555
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003556 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3557 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3558 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3559 front of an existing proxy.
3560
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003561 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3562
3563 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3564 http-server-close".
3565
3566
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003567option httpchk
3568option httpchk <uri>
3569option httpchk <method> <uri>
3570option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3571 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3573 yes | no | yes | yes
3574 Arguments :
3575 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3576 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3577 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3578 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3579 ones.
3580
3581 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3582 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3583 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3584
3585 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3586 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3587 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3588 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3589 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3590
3591 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3592 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3593 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3594 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3595 the lack of any response.
3596
3597 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3598
3599 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3600 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3601 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3602
3603 Examples :
3604 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3605 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3606 backend https_relay
3607 mode tcp
3608 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3609 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3610
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003611 See also : "option lb-agent-chk", "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk",
3612 "option mysql-check", "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and
3613 the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003614
3615
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003616option httpclose
3617no option httpclose
3618 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3620 yes | yes | yes | yes
3621 Arguments : none
3622
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003623 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3624 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3625 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3626 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3627 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3628 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3629 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003630
3631 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003632 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003633 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3634 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3635 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3636 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3637 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003638
3639 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3640 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3641 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003642 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3643 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003644
3645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3647
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003648 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3649 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003650
3651
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003652option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003653 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003656 Arguments :
3657 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3658 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3659 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3660 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3661 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003662
3663 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3664 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3665 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3666 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3667 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3668 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3669 ports.
3670
3671 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3672
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003673 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3674 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3675 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3676 by default.
3677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003678 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003679
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003680
3681option http_proxy
3682no option http_proxy
3683 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3685 yes | yes | yes | yes
3686 Arguments : none
3687
3688 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3689 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3690 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3691 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3692 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3693
3694 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3695 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3696 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3697 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003698 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003699 be analyzed.
3700
3701 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3702 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3703
3704 Example :
3705 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3706 backend direct_forward
3707 option httpclose
3708 option http_proxy
3709
3710 See also : "option httpclose"
3711
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003712
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003713option independent-streams
3714no option independent-streams
3715 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 yes | yes | yes | yes
3718 Arguments : none
3719
3720 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3721 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3722 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3723 receive data or not.
3724
3725 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3726 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3727 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3728 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3729 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3730 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3731 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3732 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3733 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3734 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3735 socket buffers.
3736
3737 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3738 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3739 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3740 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3741 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3742
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003743 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3744 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3745 deprecated.
3746
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003747 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003748
3749
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003750option lb-agent-chk
3751 Use a TCP connection to obtain a metric of server health
3752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3753 yes | no | yes | yes
3754 Arguments : none
3755
3756 This alters health checking behaviour by connecting making a TCP
3757 connection and reading an ASCII string. The string should have one of
3758 the following forms:
3759
3760 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
3761 e.g. "75%"
3762
3763 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
3764 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
3765
3766 * The string "drain".
3767
3768 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
3769 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
3770 persistence.
3771
3772 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
3773
3774 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
3775
3776 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
3777
3778 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3779
3780 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
3781
3782 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3783
3784 The use of an alternate check-port, used to obtain agent heath check
3785 information described above as opposed to the port of the service, may be
3786 useful in conjunction with this option.
3787
3788
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003789option ldap-check
3790 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3792 yes | no | yes | yes
3793 Arguments : none
3794
3795 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3796 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3797 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3798 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3799
3800 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3801 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3802
3803 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3804 configure it.
3805
3806 Example :
3807 option ldap-check
3808
3809 See also : "option httpchk"
3810
3811
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003812option log-health-checks
3813no option log-health-checks
3814 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3816 yes | no | yes | yes
3817 Arguments : none
3818
3819 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3820 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3821 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3822 of additional information is limited.
3823
3824 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3825 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3826
3827 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3828
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003829
3830option log-separate-errors
3831no option log-separate-errors
3832 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3834 yes | yes | yes | no
3835 Arguments : none
3836
3837 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3838 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3839 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3840 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3841 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3842 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3843 provides very important information.
3844
3845 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3846 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3847 error logs.
3848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003849 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003850 logging.
3851
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003852
3853option logasap
3854no option logasap
3855 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3857 yes | yes | yes | no
3858 Arguments : none
3859
3860 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3861 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3862 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3863 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3864 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3865 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3866 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003867 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003868 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3869 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3870
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003871 Examples :
3872 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3873 mode http
3874 option httplog
3875 option logasap
3876 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3877
3878 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3879 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3880 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3881 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003883 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003884 logging.
3885
3886
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003887option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3888 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3890 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003891 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003892 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3893 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003894
3895 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3896 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3897 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3898 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3899 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3900 in the MySQL table, like this :
3901
3902 USE mysql;
3903 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3904 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3905
3906 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3907 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3908 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3909 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3910 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3911 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3912 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3913 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3914 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3915
3916 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3917 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003918
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003919 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003920
3921 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3922 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3923 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3924 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3925 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3926 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3927
3928 See also: "option httpchk"
3929
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003930option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3931 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3933 yes | no | yes | yes
3934 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003935 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3936 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003937
3938 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3939 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3940 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3941 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3942
3943 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003944
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003945option nolinger
3946no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003947 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3949 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003950 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003951
3952 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3953 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3954 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3955 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3956 connections.
3957
3958 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3959 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3960 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3961 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3962 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3963 this too.
3964
3965 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3966 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3967 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3968
3969 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3970 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3971 for servers.
3972
3973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3975
3976
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003977option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3978 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3980 yes | yes | yes | yes
3981 Arguments :
3982 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3983 matching <network>
3984 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3985 header name.
3986
3987 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3988 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3989 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3990 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3991 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3992 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3993 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3994 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3995 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3996 possible that the client has already brought one.
3997
3998 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3999 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4000 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4001 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4002 header and requires different one.
4003
4004 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4005 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4006 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4007 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4008 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4009 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4010 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4011
4012 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4013 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4014 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4015 both are defined.
4016
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004017 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4018 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4019 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4020 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4021 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004022
4023 Examples :
4024 # Original Destination address
4025 frontend www
4026 mode http
4027 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4028
4029 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4030 backend www
4031 mode http
4032 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4033
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004034 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4035 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004036
4037
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004038option persist
4039no option persist
4040 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4042 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004043 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004044
4045 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4046 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4047 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4048 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4049 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4050 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4051 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4052 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4053 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4054 redirected to another valid server.
4055
4056 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4057 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4058
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004059 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004060
4061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004062option redispatch
4063no option redispatch
4064 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004067 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004068
4069 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4070 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4071 be able to access the service anymore.
4072
4073 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4074 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4075
4076 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4077 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4078 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004080 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4081 "redisp" keywords.
4082
4083 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4084 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4085
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004086 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004087
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004088
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004089option redis-check
4090 Use redis health checks for server testing
4091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4092 yes | no | yes | yes
4093 Arguments : none
4094
4095 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4096 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4097 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4098 find the "+PONG" response message.
4099
4100 Example :
4101 option redis-check
4102
4103 See also : "option httpchk"
4104
4105
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004106option smtpchk
4107option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4108 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4110 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004111 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004112 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4113 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4114 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4115
4116 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4117 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4118 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4119
4120 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4121 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4122 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4123 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4124 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4125 dead server.
4126
4127 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4128 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4129 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4130 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4131
4132 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4133 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4134 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4135 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4136 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4137
4138 Example :
4139 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4140
4141 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004144option socket-stats
4145no option socket-stats
4146
4147 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 yes | yes | yes | no
4150
4151 Arguments : none
4152
4153
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004154option splice-auto
4155no option splice-auto
4156 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | yes | yes | yes
4159 Arguments : none
4160
4161 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4162 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4163 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4164 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004165 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004166 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4167 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4168 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4169 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4170
4171 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4172 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4173 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4174 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4175 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4176 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4177 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4178 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4179 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4180 keyword.
4181
4182 Example :
4183 option splice-auto
4184
4185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4187
4188 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4189 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4190
4191
4192option splice-request
4193no option splice-request
4194 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 yes | yes | yes | yes
4197 Arguments : none
4198
4199 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004200 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004201 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4202 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4203 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4204 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4205
4206 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4207
4208 Example :
4209 option splice-request
4210
4211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4213
4214 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4215 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4216
4217
4218option splice-response
4219no option splice-response
4220 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4222 yes | yes | yes | yes
4223 Arguments : none
4224
4225 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004226 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004227 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4228 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4229 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4230 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4231
4232 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4233
4234 Example :
4235 option splice-response
4236
4237 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4238 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4239
4240 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4241 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4242
4243
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004244option srvtcpka
4245no option srvtcpka
4246 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 yes | no | yes | yes
4249 Arguments : none
4250
4251 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4252 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4253 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4254 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4255
4256 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4257 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4258 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4259 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4260
4261 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4262 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4263 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4264 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4265 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4266
4267 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4268
4269 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4270 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4271 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4272
4273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4275
4276 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4277
4278
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004279option ssl-hello-chk
4280 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4282 yes | no | yes | yes
4283 Arguments : none
4284
4285 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4286 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4287 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4288 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4289 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4290 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4291 hello message.
4292
4293 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4294 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4295 messages, which is appreciable.
4296
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004297 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4298 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4299 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004300
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004301 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4302
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004303
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004304option tcp-smart-accept
4305no option tcp-smart-accept
4306 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4308 yes | yes | yes | no
4309 Arguments : none
4310
4311 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4312 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4313 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4314 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4315 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4316 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4317
4318 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4319 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4320 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4321 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4322
4323 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4324 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4325 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4326 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4327
4328 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4329 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4330 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4331
4332 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4333 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4334 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4335
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004336 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4337
4338
4339option tcp-smart-connect
4340no option tcp-smart-connect
4341 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4343 yes | no | yes | yes
4344 Arguments : none
4345
4346 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4347 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4348 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4349 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4350 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4351
4352 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4353 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4354 complex.
4355
4356 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4357 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4358 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4359
4360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4362
4363 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4364
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004365
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004366option tcpka
4367 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4369 yes | yes | yes | yes
4370 Arguments : none
4371
4372 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4373 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4374 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4375 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4376
4377 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4378 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4379 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4380 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4381
4382 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4383 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4384 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4385 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4386 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4387
4388 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4389
4390 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4391 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4392 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4393 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4394 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4395 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4396 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4397 backends.
4398
4399 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4400
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004401
4402option tcplog
4403 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4405 yes | yes | yes | yes
4406 Arguments : none
4407
4408 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4409 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4410 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4411 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4412 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4413 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4414 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4415 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4416
4417 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004419 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004420
4421
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004422option transparent
4423no option transparent
4424 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004426 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004427 Arguments : none
4428
4429 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4430 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4431 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4432 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4433 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4434 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4435 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4436 appropriate server.
4437
4438 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4439 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4440
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004441 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004442 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004443
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004444
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004445persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004446persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004447 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 yes | no | yes | yes
4450 Arguments :
4451 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004452 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4453 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004454
4455 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4456 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4457 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4458 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4459 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4460 forwarded to this server.
4461
4462 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4463 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4464 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004465 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004466 a single "listen" section.
4467
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004468 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4469 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4470 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4471
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004472 Example :
4473 listen tse-farm
4474 bind :3389
4475 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4476 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4477 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4478 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4479 persist rdp-cookie
4480 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004481 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004482 balance rdp-cookie
4483 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4484 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4485
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004486 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4487 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004488
4489
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004490rate-limit sessions <rate>
4491 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4493 yes | yes | yes | no
4494 Arguments :
4495 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4496 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4497
4498 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4499 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4500 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4501 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4502 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4503 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4504
4505 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4506 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4507 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4508 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4509
4510 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4511 listen smtp
4512 mode tcp
4513 bind :25
4514 rate-limit sessions 10
4515 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4516
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004517 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4518 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4519 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004520
4521 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4522
4523
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004524redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4525redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4526redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004527 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 no | yes | yes | yes
4530
4531 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004532 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004533
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004534 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004535 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4536 the HTTP "Location" header.
4537
4538 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4539 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4540 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4541 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4542 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4543 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4544
4545 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4546 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4547 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4548 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4549 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4550 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4551 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4552 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4553 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004554
4555 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4556 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4557 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4558 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4559 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4560 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4561 location with a GET method.
4562
4563 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4564 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4565
4566 - "drop-query"
4567 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4568 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4569 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4570 with a location-type redirect.
4571
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004572 - "append-slash"
4573 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4574 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4575 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4576 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4577
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004578 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4579 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4580 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4581 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4582 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4583 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4584 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4585
4586 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4587 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4588 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4589 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4590 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4591 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4592 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004593
4594 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4595 acl clear dst_port 80
4596 acl secure dst_port 8080
4597 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004598 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004599 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004600 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4601
4602 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004603 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4604 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4605 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004606 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004607
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004608 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4609 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4610 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4611
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004612 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004613 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004615 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004616
4617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004618redisp (deprecated)
4619redispatch (deprecated)
4620 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4622 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004623 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004624
4625 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4626 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4627 be able to access the service anymore.
4628
4629 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4630 redistribute them to a working server.
4631
4632 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4633 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4634 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004636 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4637 "option redispatch" instead.
4638
4639 See also : "option redispatch"
4640
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004641
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004642reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004643 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4645 no | yes | yes | yes
4646 Arguments :
4647 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4648 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004649 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004650
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004651 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4652 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4653
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004654 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4655 the last header of an HTTP request.
4656
4657 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4658 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4659 responses.
4660
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004661 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4662 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4663 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4664
4665 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4666 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004667
4668
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004669reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4670reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004671 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 no | yes | yes | yes
4674 Arguments :
4675 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4676 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4677 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4678 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4679 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4680 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4681 ignores case.
4682
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004683 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4684 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4685
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004686 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4687 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4688 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4689 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004690 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004691
4692 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4693 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4694
4695 Example :
4696 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4697 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4698 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4699
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004700 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4701 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004702
4703
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004704reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4705reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004706 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 no | yes | yes | yes
4709 Arguments :
4710 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4711 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4712 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4713 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4714 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4715 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4716
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004717 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4718 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4719
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004720 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4721 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4722 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4723 next servers.
4724
4725 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4726 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4727 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4728
4729 Example :
4730 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4731 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4732 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4733
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004734 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4735 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004736
4737
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004738reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4739reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004740 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4742 no | yes | yes | yes
4743 Arguments :
4744 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4745 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4746 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4747 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4748 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4749 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4750 case.
4751
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004752 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4753 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4754
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004755 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4756 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4757 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4758 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004759 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004760
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004761 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004762 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004763 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004764
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004765 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4766 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4767
4768 Example :
4769 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4770 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4771 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4772
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004773 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4774 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004775
4776
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004777reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4778reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004779 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 no | yes | yes | yes
4782 Arguments :
4783 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4784 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4785 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4786 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4787 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4788 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4789 case.
4790
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004791 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4792 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4793
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004794 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4795 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4796 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4797 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4798
4799 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4800 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4801
4802 Example :
4803 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4804 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4805 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4806 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4807
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004808 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4809 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004810
4811
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004812reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4813reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004814 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4816 no | yes | yes | yes
4817 Arguments :
4818 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4819 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4820 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4821 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4822 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4823 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4824
4825 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4826 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4827 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4828 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004829 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004830
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004831 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4832 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4833
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004834 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4835 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4836 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4837
4838 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4839 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4840 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4841 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4842 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4843
4844 Example :
4845 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004846 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004847 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4848 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4849
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004850 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4851 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004852
4853
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004854reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4855reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004856 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4858 no | yes | yes | yes
4859 Arguments :
4860 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4861 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4862 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4863 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4864 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4865 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4866 ignores case.
4867
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004868 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4869 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4870
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004871 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4872 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004873 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4874 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4875 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004876 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4877 not set.
4878
4879 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4880 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4881 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4882 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4883 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4884
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004885 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004886 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4887 # block all others.
4888 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4889 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4890
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004891 # block bad guys
4892 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4893 reqitarpit . if badguys
4894
4895 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4896 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004897
4898
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004899retries <value>
4900 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4901 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4902 yes | no | yes | yes
4903 Arguments :
4904 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4905 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4906 default value is 3.
4907
4908 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4909 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4910 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4911
4912 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4913 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4914
4915 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4916 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4917
4918 See also : "option redispatch"
4919
4920
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004921rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004922 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4924 no | yes | yes | yes
4925 Arguments :
4926 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4927 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004928 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004929
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004930 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4931 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4932
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004933 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4934 the last header of an HTTP response.
4935
4936 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4937 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4938 responses.
4939
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004940 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4941 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004942
4943
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004944rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4945rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004946 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4948 no | yes | yes | yes
4949 Arguments :
4950 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4951 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4952 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4953 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4954 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4955 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4956 ignores case.
4957
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004958 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4959 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4960
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004961 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4962 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004963 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004964 client.
4965
4966 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4967 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4968 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4969
4970 Example :
4971 # remove the Server header from responses
4972 reqidel ^Server:.*
4973
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004974 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4975 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004976
4977
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004978rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4979rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004980 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4982 no | yes | yes | yes
4983 Arguments :
4984 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4985 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4986 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4987 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4988 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4989 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4990 ignores case.
4991
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004992 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4993 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4994
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004995 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4996 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4997 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4998 case-sensitive.
4999
5000 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005001 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5002 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5003 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005004
5005 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5006 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5007
5008 Example :
5009 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5010 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5011
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005012 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5013 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005014
5015
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005016rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5017rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005018 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5020 no | yes | yes | yes
5021 Arguments :
5022 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5023 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5024 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5025 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5026 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5027 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5028 ignores case.
5029
5030 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5031 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5032 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5033 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005034 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005035
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005036 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5037 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5038
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005039 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5040 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5041 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5042
5043 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5044 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5045 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5046 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5047 are not case-sensitive.
5048
5049 Example :
5050 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5051 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5052
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005053 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5054 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005055
5056
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005057server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005058 Declare a server in a backend
5059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5060 no | no | yes | yes
5061 Arguments :
5062 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005063 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005064 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005065
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005066 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5067 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5068 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5069 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005070 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5071 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5072 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5073 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5074 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
5075 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005077 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005078 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5079 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5080 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5081 adding this value to the client's port.
5082
5083 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5084 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005085 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005086
5087 Examples :
5088 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5089 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
5090
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005091 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5092 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005093
5094
5095source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005096source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005097source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005098 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5100 yes | no | yes | yes
5101 Arguments :
5102 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5103 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
5104 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
5105 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
5106
5107 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5108 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005109 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5110 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5111 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005112
5113 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5114 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5115 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5116 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5117 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5118 <addr>.
5119
5120 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5121 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5122 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5123 port.
5124
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005125 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5126 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5127 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5128 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005129 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005130 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5131 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5132 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5133 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5134 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5135 HTTP header.
5136
5137 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5138 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005139 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005140 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5141 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5142 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5143 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5144 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5145 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5146 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5147
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005148 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5149 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5150 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5151 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5152 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5153 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5154
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005155 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5156 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5157 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5158 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5159
5160 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5161 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5162 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5163 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5164 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5165 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5166
5167 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5168 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5169 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5170 there are two methods :
5171
5172 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5173 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5174 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5175 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5176 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5177 of the client ranges may be used.
5178
5179 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5180 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5181 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5182 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5183 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5184 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5185 same session.
5186
5187 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5188 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5189 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5190 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5191 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5192 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5193
5194 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5195 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5196 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005197 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005198
5199 Examples :
5200 backend private
5201 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5202 source 192.168.1.200
5203
5204 backend transparent_ssl1
5205 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5206 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5207
5208 backend transparent_ssl2
5209 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5210 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5211 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5212
5213 backend transparent_ssl3
5214 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5215 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5216 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5217
5218 backend transparent_smtp
5219 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5220 # with Tproxy version 4.
5221 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5222
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005223 backend transparent_http
5224 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5225 # proxy.
5226 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005228 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005229 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005231
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005232srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5233 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5235 yes | no | yes | yes
5236 Arguments :
5237 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5238 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5239 as explained at the top of this document.
5240
5241 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5242 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5243 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5244 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5245 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5246 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5247 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5248
5249 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5250 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5251 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5252 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5253 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005254 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005255 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005256 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005257
5258 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5260 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5261 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5262 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5263 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5264
5265 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5266 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5267
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005268 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5269 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005270
5271
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005272stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5273 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5275 no | no | yes | yes
5276
5277 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5278 matched.
5279
5280 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5281 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5282
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005283 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5284 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5285 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5286
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005287 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5288 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5289 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5290 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005291
5292 Example :
5293 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5294 backend stats_localhost
5295 stats enable
5296 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5297
5298 Example :
5299 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5300 backend stats_auth
5301 stats enable
5302 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5303 stats admin if TRUE
5304
5305 Example :
5306 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5307 userlist stats-auth
5308 group admin users admin
5309 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5310 group readonly users haproxy
5311 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5312
5313 backend stats_auth
5314 stats enable
5315 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5316 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5317 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5318 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5319
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005320 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5321 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5322 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005323
5324
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005325stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5326 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | no | yes | yes
5329 Arguments :
5330 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5331
5332 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5333
5334 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5335 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5336 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5337 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5338 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5339 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5340
5341 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5342 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5343 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005344 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005345
5346 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5347 report using "stats scope".
5348
5349 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5350 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5351 unobvious parameters.
5352
5353 Example :
5354 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5355 backend public_www
5356 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5357 stats enable
5358 stats hide-version
5359 stats scope .
5360 stats uri /admin?stats
5361 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5362 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5363 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5364
5365 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5366 backend private_monitoring
5367 stats enable
5368 stats uri /admin?stats
5369 stats refresh 5s
5370
5371 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5372
5373
5374stats enable
5375 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5377 yes | no | yes | yes
5378 Arguments : none
5379
5380 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5381 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5382 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5383 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5384 - stats auth : no authentication
5385 - stats scope : no restriction
5386
5387 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5388 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5389 unobvious parameters.
5390
5391 Example :
5392 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5393 backend public_www
5394 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5395 stats enable
5396 stats hide-version
5397 stats scope .
5398 stats uri /admin?stats
5399 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5400 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5401 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5402
5403 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5404 backend private_monitoring
5405 stats enable
5406 stats uri /admin?stats
5407 stats refresh 5s
5408
5409 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5410
5411
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005412stats hide-version
5413 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5415 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005416 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005417
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005418 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5419 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5420 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5421 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5422 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5423 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005425 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5426 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5427 unobvious parameters.
5428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005429 Example :
5430 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5431 backend public_www
5432 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005433 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005434 stats hide-version
5435 stats scope .
5436 stats uri /admin?stats
5437 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5438 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5439 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005440
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005441 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5442 backend private_monitoring
5443 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005444 stats uri /admin?stats
5445 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005446
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005447 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005448
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005449
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005450stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5451 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5452 Access control for statistics
5453
5454 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 no | no | yes | yes
5456
5457 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5458 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5459 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5460 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5461 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5462 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5463
5464 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5465 instance.
5466
5467 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5468 about ACL usage.
5469
5470
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005471stats realm <realm>
5472 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5474 yes | no | yes | yes
5475 Arguments :
5476 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5477 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5478 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5479
5480 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5481 using a backslash ('\').
5482
5483 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5484 only related to authentication.
5485
5486 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5487 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5488 unobvious parameters.
5489
5490 Example :
5491 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5492 backend public_www
5493 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5494 stats enable
5495 stats hide-version
5496 stats scope .
5497 stats uri /admin?stats
5498 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5499 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5500 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5501
5502 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5503 backend private_monitoring
5504 stats enable
5505 stats uri /admin?stats
5506 stats refresh 5s
5507
5508 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5509
5510
5511stats refresh <delay>
5512 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5514 yes | no | yes | yes
5515 Arguments :
5516 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5517 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5518 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5519 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5520 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5521 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5522
5523 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5524 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5525 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5526 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5527
5528 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5529 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5530 unobvious parameters.
5531
5532 Example :
5533 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5534 backend public_www
5535 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5536 stats enable
5537 stats hide-version
5538 stats scope .
5539 stats uri /admin?stats
5540 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5541 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5542 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5543
5544 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5545 backend private_monitoring
5546 stats enable
5547 stats uri /admin?stats
5548 stats refresh 5s
5549
5550 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5551
5552
5553stats scope { <name> | "." }
5554 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5556 yes | no | yes | yes
5557 Arguments :
5558 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5559 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5560 section in which the statement appears.
5561
5562 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5563 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5564 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5565 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5566 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5567 exists.
5568
5569 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5570 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5571 unobvious parameters.
5572
5573 Example :
5574 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5575 backend public_www
5576 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5577 stats enable
5578 stats hide-version
5579 stats scope .
5580 stats uri /admin?stats
5581 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5582 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5583 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5584
5585 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5586 backend private_monitoring
5587 stats enable
5588 stats uri /admin?stats
5589 stats refresh 5s
5590
5591 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5592
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005593
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005594stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005595 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5597 yes | no | yes | yes
5598
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005599 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005600 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5601
5602 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5603 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5604
5605 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5606 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005607 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005608
5609 Example :
5610 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5611 backend private_monitoring
5612 stats enable
5613 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5614 stats uri /admin?stats
5615 stats refresh 5s
5616
5617 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5618 global section.
5619
5620
5621stats show-legends
5622 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5623 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5624 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5625 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5626 - IP (socket, server)
5627 - cookie (backend, server)
5628
5629 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5630 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005631 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005632
5633 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5634
5635
5636stats show-node [ <name> ]
5637 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5639 yes | no | yes | yes
5640 Arguments:
5641 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5642 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5643
5644 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5645 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005646 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005647
5648 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5649 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5650 unobvious parameters.
5651
5652 Example:
5653 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5654 backend private_monitoring
5655 stats enable
5656 stats show-node Europe-1
5657 stats uri /admin?stats
5658 stats refresh 5s
5659
5660 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5661 section.
5662
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005663
5664stats uri <prefix>
5665 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5667 yes | no | yes | yes
5668 Arguments :
5669 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5670 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5671 query string.
5672
5673 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5674 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5675 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5676 possible to reach it in the application.
5677
5678 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005679 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005680 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5681 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5682 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5683 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5684
5685 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5686 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5687 an address or a port to statistics only.
5688
5689 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5690 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5691 unobvious parameters.
5692
5693 Example :
5694 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5695 backend public_www
5696 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5697 stats enable
5698 stats hide-version
5699 stats scope .
5700 stats uri /admin?stats
5701 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5702 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5703 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5704
5705 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5706 backend private_monitoring
5707 stats enable
5708 stats uri /admin?stats
5709 stats refresh 5s
5710
5711 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5712
5713
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005714stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5715 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005717 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005718
5719 Arguments :
5720 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5721 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5722 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5723 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5724
5725 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5726 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5727 the "stick-table" statement.
5728
5729 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5730 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5731 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5732 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5733 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5734
5735 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5736 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5737 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5738 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5739 transformation rules.
5740
5741 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5742 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5743 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5744 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5745 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5746 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5747 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5748
5749 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5750 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5751 ACL based conditions.
5752
5753 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5754 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5755 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5756 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5757
5758 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5759 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5760 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5761 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5762
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005763 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5764 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5765 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5766
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005767 Example :
5768 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5769 # last 30 minutes
5770 backend pop
5771 mode tcp
5772 balance roundrobin
5773 stick store-request src
5774 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5775 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5776 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5777
5778 backend smtp
5779 mode tcp
5780 balance roundrobin
5781 stick match src table pop
5782 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5783 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5784
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005785 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5786 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005787
5788
5789stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5790 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5792 no | no | yes | yes
5793
5794 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5795 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5796 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5797 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5798
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005799 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5800 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5801 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5802
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005803 Examples :
5804 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005805 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005806
5807 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5808 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5809 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5810
5811
5812 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5813 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5814 backend http
5815 mode http
5816 balance roundrobin
5817 stick on src table https
5818 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5819 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5820 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5821
5822 backend https
5823 mode tcp
5824 balance roundrobin
5825 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5826 stick on src
5827 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5828 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5829
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005830 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005831
5832
5833stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5834 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5836 no | no | yes | yes
5837
5838 Arguments :
5839 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5840 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5841 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5842 server is selected.
5843
5844 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5845 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5846 the "stick-table" statement.
5847
5848 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5849 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5850 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5851 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5852 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5853 address.
5854
5855 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5856 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5857 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5858 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5859 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5860 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5861 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5862 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5863 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5864 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5865
5866 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5867 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5868 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5869 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5870 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5871 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5872 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5873
5874 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5875 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5876 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5877 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5878
5879 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5880 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5881 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5882 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5883 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5884 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5885 another protocol or access method.
5886
5887 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5888 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5889 the request.
5890
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005891 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5892 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5893 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5894
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005895 Example :
5896 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5897 # last 30 minutes
5898 backend pop
5899 mode tcp
5900 balance roundrobin
5901 stick store-request src
5902 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5903 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5904 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5905
5906 backend smtp
5907 mode tcp
5908 balance roundrobin
5909 stick match src table pop
5910 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5911 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5912
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005913 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5914 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005915
5916
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005917stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005918 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5919 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005920 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005922 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005923
5924 Arguments :
5925 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5926 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5927 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5928 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5929
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005930 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5931 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5932 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5933 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5934
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005935 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5936 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5937 instance.
5938
5939 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5940 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5941 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5942 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5943 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5944 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005945 to 32 characters.
5946
5947 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5948 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5949 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5950 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5951 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5952 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005953
5954 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005955 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5956 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005957 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5958 increase.
5959
5960 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005961 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5962 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5963 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005964
5965 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5966 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5967 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5968 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5969 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5970 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5971 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5972 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5973 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5974 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5975 parameter (see below).
5976
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005977 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5978 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5979 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5980 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5981 soft restart.
5982
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005983 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5984
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005985 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5986 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5987 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5988 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5989 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005990 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005991 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5992 if not expiration delay is specified.
5993
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005994 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5995 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5996 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5997 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005998 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5999 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6000 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6001 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6002 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6003 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6004 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6005 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6006 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6007 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6008 types and their arguments.
6009
6010 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6011 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6012 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6013 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6014
6015 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6016 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6017 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6018 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6019
6020 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6021 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6022 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6023 they were received.
6024
6025 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6026 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6027 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6028 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6029 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6030
6031 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6032 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6033 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6034 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6035 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6036
6037 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6038 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6039 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6040
6041 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6042 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6043 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6044 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6045 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6046
6047 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6048 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6049 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6050 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6051 the client side.
6052
6053 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6054 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6055 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6056 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6057 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6058 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6059 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6060
6061 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6062 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6063 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6064 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6065 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6066 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6067 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6068
6069 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6070 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6071 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6072 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6073 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6074 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6075
6076 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6077 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6078 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6079 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6080
6081 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6082 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6083 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6084 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6085 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6086 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6087 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6088 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6089 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6090 recommended for better fairness.
6091
6092 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6093 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6094 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6095 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6096
6097 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6098 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6099 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6100 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6101 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6102 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6103 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6104 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6105 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6106 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006107
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006108 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6109 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006110 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6111 reference it.
6112
6113 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6114 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6115 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6116 as an exclusive stickiness.
6117
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006118 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6119 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6120 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6121 something that can be ignored.
6122
6123 Example:
6124 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6125 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6126 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6127 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6128
6129 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006130 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006131
6132
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006133stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6134 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6136 no | no | yes | yes
6137
6138 Arguments :
6139 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6140 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6141 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6142 server is selected.
6143
6144 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6145 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6146 the "stick-table" statement.
6147
6148 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6149 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6150 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6151 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6152
6153 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6154 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6155 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6156 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6157 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6158 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006159 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006160 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6161 rules.
6162
6163 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6164 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6165 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6166 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6167 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6168 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6169 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6170
6171 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6172 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6173 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6174 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6175
6176 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6177 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6178 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6179 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6180 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6181 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6182 another protocol or access method.
6183
6184 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6185
6186 Example :
6187 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6188 backend https
6189 mode tcp
6190 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006191 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006192 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006193
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006194 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6195 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6196
6197 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6198 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6199 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6200
6201 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6202 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006203
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006204 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6205 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6206 # at offset 44.
6207
6208 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6209 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6210
6211 # Learn on response if server hello.
6212 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006213
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006214 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6215 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6216
6217 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6218 extraction.
6219
6220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006221tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6222 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6224 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006225 Arguments :
6226 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6227 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6228 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006229
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006230 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006231
6232 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6233 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006234 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6235 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6236 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6237 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6238 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6239 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006241 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6242 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6243 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6244 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006246 Three types of actions are supported :
6247 - accept :
6248 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6249 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6250 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006252 - reject :
6253 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6254 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6255 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6256 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6257 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6258 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6259 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6260 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6261 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6262 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6263 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6264 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006266 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6267 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6268 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6269 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6270 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6271 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6272 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6273 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6274 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006275
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006276 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006277 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
6278 in section 7.8. It describes what elements of the incoming
6279 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6280 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6281 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6282 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006284 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6285 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6286 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6287 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006288
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006289 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6290 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6291 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6292 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6293 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006294 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6295 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6296 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6297 layer7 information is extracted.
6298
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006299 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6300 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6301 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6302 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6303 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006305 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6306 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6307 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006309 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6310 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6311 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006312
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006313 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006314 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006315 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006317 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6318 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6319 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006321 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6322 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6323 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006324
6325 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6326
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006327 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006328
6329
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006330tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6331 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006333 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006334 Arguments :
6335 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6336 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6337 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006338
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006339 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006341 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6342 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6343 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6344 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6345 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006347 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6348 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6349 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6350 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6351 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6352 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6353 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6354 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6355 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006356
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006357 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6358 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6359 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6360 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006361
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006362 Three types of actions are supported :
6363 - accept :
6364 - reject :
6365 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006366
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006367 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6368 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006370 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6371 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6372 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006373 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6374 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6375 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6376 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
6377 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track per-frontend
6378 counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006380 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006381 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6382 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006383
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006384 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006385 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6386 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6387 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6388 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6389 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006390
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006391 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6392 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6393 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6394 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6395
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006396 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006397 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6398 # and reject everything else.
6399 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6400 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006401 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006402 tcp-request content reject
6403
6404 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006405 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6406 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6407 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006408 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006409
6410 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6411 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6412 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006413 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006414 tcp-request content reject
6415
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006416 Example:
6417 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6418 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6419 tcp-request content track-sc1 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
6420
6421 Example:
6422 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6423 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6424 tcp-request content track-sc1 base table req-rate if HTTP
6425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006426 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6427 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6428
6429 frontend http
6430 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6431 # protecting all our sites
6432 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6433 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6434 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6435 ...
6436 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6437
6438 backend http_dynamic
6439 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6440 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6441 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6442 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01006443 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006444 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6445 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006447 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006449 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006450
6451
6452tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6453 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006455 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006456 Arguments :
6457 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6458 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6459 as explained at the top of this document.
6460
6461 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6462 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6463 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6464 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6465 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6466
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006467 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6468 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6469 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6470 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6471
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006472 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6473 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006474 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006475 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006476 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6477 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6478 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6479 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006480
6481 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6482 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6483 it pass through unaffected.
6484
6485 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6486 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6487 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006488 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006489 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6490 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006491 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6492 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6493 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006494
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006495 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006496 "timeout client".
6497
6498
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006499tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6500 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 no | no | yes | yes
6503 Arguments :
6504 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6505 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6506 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6507
6508 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6509
6510 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6511 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6512 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6513 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006514 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006515
6516 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6517
6518 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6519 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6520 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6521 inserted.
6522
6523 Two types of actions are supported :
6524 - accept :
6525 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6526 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6527 the rules evaluation.
6528
6529 - reject :
6530 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6531 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006532 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006533
6534 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6535 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6536 for changing the default action to a reject.
6537
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006538 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6539 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6540 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6541 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006542 period.
6543
6544 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6545
6546 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6547
6548
6549tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6550 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6552 no | no | yes | yes
6553 Arguments :
6554 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6555 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6556 as explained at the top of this document.
6557
6558 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6559
6560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006561timeout check <timeout>
6562 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6563 established.
6564
6565 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6566 yes | no | yes | yes
6567 Arguments:
6568 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6569 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6570 as explained at the top of this document.
6571
6572 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6573 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6574 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6575 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006576 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6577 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6578 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006579
6580 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6581 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6582
6583 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6584 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006585 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006586
6587 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6588 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6589 forget about it.
6590
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006591 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6592 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006593
6594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006595timeout client <timeout>
6596timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6597 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 yes | yes | yes | no
6600 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006601 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006602 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6603 as explained at the top of this document.
6604
6605 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6606 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6607 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6608 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6609 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6610 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6611 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6612 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006613 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006614 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006615 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6616 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6617 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006618
6619 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6620 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6621 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6622 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6623 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6624 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6625
6626 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6627 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6628 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6629
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006630 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006631
6632
6633timeout connect <timeout>
6634timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6635 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6637 yes | no | yes | yes
6638 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006639 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006640 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6641 as explained at the top of this document.
6642
6643 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006644 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006645 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006646 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006647 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6648 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006649
6650 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6651 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6652 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6653 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6654 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6655 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6656
6657 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6658 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6659 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6660
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006661 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6662 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006663
6664
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006665timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6666 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 yes | yes | yes | yes
6669 Arguments :
6670 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6671 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6672 as explained at the top of this document.
6673
6674 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6675 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6676 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6677 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6678 once the request has started to present itself.
6679
6680 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6681 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6682 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6683 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6684 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6685
6686 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6687 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6688 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6689 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6690
6691 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6692 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6693 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6694 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6695 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006696 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006697
6698 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6699 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6700 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6701 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6702
6703 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6704
6705
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006706timeout http-request <timeout>
6707 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006709 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006710 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006711 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006712 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6713 as explained at the top of this document.
6714
6715 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6716 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6717 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6718 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6719 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6720 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6721 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6722 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6723
6724 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6725 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006726 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6727 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006728
6729 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6730 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6731 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6732 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6733 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6734
6735 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006736 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6737 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6738 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006739
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006740 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006741
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006742
6743timeout queue <timeout>
6744 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6746 yes | no | yes | yes
6747 Arguments :
6748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6750 as explained at the top of this document.
6751
6752 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6753 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6754 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6755 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6756 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6757
6758 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6759 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6760 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6761 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6762
6763 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6764
6765
6766timeout server <timeout>
6767timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6768 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6770 yes | no | yes | yes
6771 Arguments :
6772 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6773 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6774 as explained at the top of this document.
6775
6776 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6777 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6778 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6779 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6780 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6781 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6782 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6783
6784 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6785 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6786 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6787 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6788 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006789 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006790 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006791 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6792 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6793 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6794 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006795
6796 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6797 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6798 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6799 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6800 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6801 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6802
6803 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6804 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6805 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6806
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006807 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006808
6809
6810timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006811 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6813 yes | yes | yes | yes
6814 Arguments :
6815 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6816 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6817 as explained at the top of this document.
6818
6819 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6820 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6821 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6822
6823 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6824 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6825 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6826 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006827 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006828
6829 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6830
6831
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006832timeout tunnel <timeout>
6833 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6835 yes | no | yes | yes
6836 Arguments :
6837 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6838 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6839 as explained at the top of this document.
6840
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006841 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006842 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6843 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6844 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6845 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6846 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6847 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6848 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6849 specified.
6850
6851 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6852 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6853 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6854 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6855 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6856
6857 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6858 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6859 forget about it.
6860
6861 Example :
6862 defaults http
6863 option http-server-close
6864 timeout connect 5s
6865 timeout client 30s
6866 timeout client 30s
6867 timeout server 30s
6868 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6869
6870 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6871
6872
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006873transparent (deprecated)
6874 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006876 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006877 Arguments : none
6878
6879 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6880 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6881 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6882 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6883 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6884 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6885 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6886 appropriate server.
6887
6888 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6889
6890 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6891 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6892
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006893 See also: "option transparent"
6894
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006895unique-id-format <string>
6896 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6898 yes | yes | yes | no
6899 Arguments :
6900 <string> is a log-format string.
6901
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006902 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6903 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6904 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6905 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006906
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006907 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6908 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6909 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6910 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6911 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6912 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6913 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6914 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006915
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006916 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6917 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006918
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006919 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006920
6921 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6922
6923 will generate:
6924
6925 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6926
6927 See also: "unique-id-header"
6928
6929unique-id-header <name>
6930 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6932 yes | yes | yes | no
6933 Arguments :
6934 <name> is the name of the header.
6935
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006936 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6937 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006938
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006939 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006940
6941 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6942 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6943
6944 will generate:
6945
6946 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6947
6948 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006949
6950use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6951use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006952 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 no | yes | yes | no
6955 Arguments :
6956 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006958 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006959
6960 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6961 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6962 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006963 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6964 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6965 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6966 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006967
6968 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6969 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6970 assign the backend.
6971
6972 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6973 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6974 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6975 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6976 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6977 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6978
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006979 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006980 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006981 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6982 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6983 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6984
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006985 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006986
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006987
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006988use-server <server> if <condition>
6989use-server <server> unless <condition>
6990 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6992 no | no | yes | yes
6993 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006994 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006995
6996 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6997
6998 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6999 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7000 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7001
7002 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7003 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7004 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7005 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7006 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7007 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7008 matches will assign the server.
7009
7010 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7011 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7012 with the next rules until one matches.
7013
7014 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7015 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7016 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7017 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7018
7019 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7020 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7021 stripped.
7022
7023 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7024 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7025 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7026 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7027
7028 Example :
7029 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7030 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7031 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7032 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7033 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7034 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7035 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7036 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7037 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7038
7039 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7040
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007041
70425. Bind and Server options
7043--------------------------
7044
7045The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7046depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7047settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7048written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7049described in this section.
7050
7051
70525.1. Bind options
7053-----------------
7054
7055The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7056as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7057no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7058parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7059while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7060provided immediately after the setting name.
7061
7062The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7063
7064accept-proxy
7065 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7066 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7067 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7068 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7069 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7070 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7071 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7072 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7073 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
7074 usable.
7075
7076backlog <backlog>
7077 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7078 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7079
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007080ecdhe <named curve>
7081 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7082 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
7083 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
7084
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007085ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007086 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7087 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7088 client's certificate.
7089
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007090ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7092 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7093 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7094 error is ignored.
7095
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007096ciphers <ciphers>
7097 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7098 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7099 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7100 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7101 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7102
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007103crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7105 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7106 to verify client's certificate.
7107
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007108crt <cert>
7109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7110 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7111 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007112 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
7113 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
7114 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
7115 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
7116 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
7117 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
7118 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
7119 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007120 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007121 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
7122 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
7123 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
7124 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7125 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007126
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007127crt-ignore-err <errors>
7128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7129 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
7130 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
7131 error is ignored.
7132
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007133defer-accept
7134 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7135 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7136 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7137 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7138 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7139 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7140 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7141 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7142 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7143 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7144 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7145
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007146force-sslv3
7147 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7148 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7149 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7150
7151force-tlsv10
7152 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7153 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7154
7155force-tlsv11
7156 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7157 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7158
7159force-tlsv12
7160 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7161 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7162
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007163gid <gid>
7164 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7165 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7166 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7167 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7168 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7169
7170group <group>
7171 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7172 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7173 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7174 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7175 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7176
7177id <id>
7178 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7179 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7180 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7181 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7182
7183interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007184 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7185 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7186 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7187 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7188 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7189 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7190 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007191
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007192level <level>
7193 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7194 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7195 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7196 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7197 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7198 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7199 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7200 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7201 counters).
7202 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7203 all counters).
7204
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007205maxconn <maxconn>
7206 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7207 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7208 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7209 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7210 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7211 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7212 eat all memory.
7213
7214mode <mode>
7215 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7216 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7217 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7218 UNIX sockets.
7219
7220mss <maxseg>
7221 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7222 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7223 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7224 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7225 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7226 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7227 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7228 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7229 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7230 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7231 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7232
7233name <name>
7234 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7235 page.
7236
7237nice <nice>
7238 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7239 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7240 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7241 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7242 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7243 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7244 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7245 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7246 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7247 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7248 one for an RDP socket.
7249
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007250no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7252 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7253 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007254 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7255 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007256
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007257no-tls-tickets
7258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7259 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7260 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7261 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7262
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007263no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007265 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7266 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7267 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7268 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007269
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007270no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007272 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7273 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7274 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7275 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007276
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007277no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007279 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7280 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7281 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7282 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007283
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007284npn <protocols>
7285 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7286 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7287 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7288 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7289 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7290
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007291ssl
7292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7293 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7294 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7295 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7296 to deciphered contents.
7297
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007298strict-sni
7299 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7300 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7301 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7302 See the "crt" option for more information.
7303
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007304tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007305 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007306 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7307 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7308 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7309 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7310 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7311 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7312 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7313 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7314
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007315transparent
7316 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7317 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7318 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7319 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7320 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7321 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7322 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7323 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7324 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7325 so check for support with your vendor.
7326
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007327v4v6
7328 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7329 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7330 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7331 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7332 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7333
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007334v6only
7335 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7336 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7337 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007338 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7339 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007340
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007341uid <uid>
7342 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7343 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7344 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7345 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7346 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7347
7348user <user>
7349 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7350 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7351 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7352 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7353 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7354
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007355verify [none|optional|required]
7356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7357 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7358 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7359 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7360 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007361 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7362 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7363 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7364 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007365
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020073665.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007367------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007369The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7370which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7371arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7372settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7373after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7374Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7375address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007377 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007378 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007380The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007381
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007382addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007383 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7384 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7385 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7386 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7387 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007389 Supported in default-server: No
7390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007391backup
7392 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7393 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7394 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7395 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7396 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7397 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007399 Supported in default-server: No
7400
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007401ca-file <cafile>
7402 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7403 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7404 server's certificate.
7405
7406 Supported in default-server: No
7407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007408check
7409 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007410 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7411 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7412 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7413 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7414 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7415 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7416 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09007417 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the
7418 "httpchk", "lb-agent-chk", "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and
7419 "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and parameters for
7420 more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007422 Supported in default-server: No
7423
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007424check-send-proxy
7425 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7426 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7427 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7428 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7429 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7430 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7431 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7432
7433 Supported in default-server: No
7434
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007435check-ssl
7436 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7437 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7438 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7439 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7440 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7441 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7442 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7443 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7444 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7445
7446 Supported in default-server: No
7447
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007448ciphers <ciphers>
7449 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7450 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7451 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7452 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7453 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7454 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7455 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7456 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7457
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007458 Supported in default-server: No
7459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007460cookie <value>
7461 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7462 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7463 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7464 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7465 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7466 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7467 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007469 Supported in default-server: No
7470
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007471crl-file <crlfile>
7472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7473 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7474 to verify server's certificate.
7475
7476 Supported in default-server: No
7477
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007478crt <cert>
7479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7480 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7481 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7482 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7483 certificate request.
7484
7485 Supported in default-server: No
7486
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007487disabled
7488 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7489 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7490 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7491 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7492 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7493
7494 Supported in default-server: No
7495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007496error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007497 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7498 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7499 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007501 Supported in default-server: Yes
7502
7503 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007505fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007506 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7507 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7508 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007510 Supported in default-server: Yes
7511
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007512force-sslv3
7513 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7514 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7515 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7516
7517 Supported in default-server: No
7518
7519force-tlsv10
7520 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7521 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7522
7523 Supported in default-server: No
7524
7525force-tlsv11
7526 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7527 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7528
7529 Supported in default-server: No
7530
7531force-tlsv12
7532 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7533 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7534
7535 Supported in default-server: No
7536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007537id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007538 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7539 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7540 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007542 Supported in default-server: No
7543
7544inter <delay>
7545fastinter <delay>
7546downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007547 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7548 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7549 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7550 between checks depending on the server state :
7551
7552 Server state | Interval used
7553 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7554 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7555 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7556 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7557 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7558 or yet unchecked. |
7559 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7560 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7561 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007563 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7564 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7565 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7566 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7567 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7568 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7569 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7570 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7571 servers.
7572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007573 Supported in default-server: Yes
7574
7575maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007576 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7577 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7578 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7579 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7580 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7581 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7582 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7583 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007585 Supported in default-server: Yes
7586
7587maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007588 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7589 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7590 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7591 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7592 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7593 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7594 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007596 Supported in default-server: Yes
7597
7598minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007599 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7600 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7601 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7602 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7603 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7604 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007605 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007606 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007608 Supported in default-server: Yes
7609
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007610no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007611 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7612 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007613 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007614
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007615 Supported in default-server: No
7616
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007617no-tls-tickets
7618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7619 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7620 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7621 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7622
7623 Supported in default-server: No
7624
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007625no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007626 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007627 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7628 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007629 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7630 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007631
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007632 Supported in default-server: No
7633
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007634no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007635 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007636 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7637 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007638 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7639 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007640
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007641 Supported in default-server: No
7642
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007643no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007644 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007645 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7646 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007647 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7648 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007649
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007650 Supported in default-server: No
7651
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007652non-stick
7653 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7654 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7655 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7656
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007657 Supported in default-server: No
7658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007659observe <mode>
7660 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7661 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7662 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7663 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7664 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7665 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007666 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007668 Supported in default-server: No
7669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007670 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007672on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007673 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7674 Currently, four modes are available:
7675 - fastinter: force fastinter
7676 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7677 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7678 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7679 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007681 Supported in default-server: Yes
7682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007683 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7684
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007685on-marked-down <action>
7686 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7687 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007688 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7689 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7690 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7691 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7692 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7693 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7694 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7695 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007696
7697 Actions are disabled by default
7698
7699 Supported in default-server: Yes
7700
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007701on-marked-up <action>
7702 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7703 Currently one action is available:
7704 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7705 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7706 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7707 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7708 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7709 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7710 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7711 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7712
7713 Actions are disabled by default
7714
7715 Supported in default-server: Yes
7716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007717port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007718 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7719 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7720 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7721 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7722 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7723 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007725 Supported in default-server: Yes
7726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007727redir <prefix>
7728 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7729 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7730 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7731 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7732 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7733 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7734 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7735 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007736 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007737 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7738 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7739 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7740 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7741 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7742
7743 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007745 Supported in default-server: No
7746
7747rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007748 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7749 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7750 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007752 Supported in default-server: Yes
7753
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007754send-proxy
7755 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7756 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7757 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7758 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7759 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7760 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7761 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7762 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7763 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007764 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7765 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7766 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7767 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7768 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007769
7770 Supported in default-server: No
7771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007772slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007773 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7774 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7775 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7776 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7777 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7778 parameters :
7779
7780 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7781 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7782
7783 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7784 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7785 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7786 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7787
7788 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7789 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7790 seen as failed.
7791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007792 Supported in default-server: Yes
7793
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007794source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007795source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007796source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007797 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7798 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7799 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7800 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7801
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007802 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7803 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7804 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7805 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7806 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7807 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7808 server.
7809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007810 Supported in default-server: No
7811
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007812ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007813 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7814 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7815 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7816 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7817 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7818 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7819 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7820 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7821
7822 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007824track [<proxy>/]<server>
7825 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7826 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7827 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7828 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7829 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007831 Supported in default-server: No
7832
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007833verify [none|required]
7834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7835 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7836 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7837 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7838 is aborted.
7839
7840 Supported in default-server: No
7841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007842weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007843 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7844 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7845 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007846 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7847 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7848 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7849 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7850 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7851 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007853 Supported in default-server: Yes
7854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007855
78566. HTTP header manipulation
7857---------------------------
7858
7859In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7860response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7861request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7862which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7863against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7864to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7865passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7866headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7867never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7868
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007869There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7870(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7871rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7872messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7873in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007874happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007875add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7876normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007878This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7879in section 4.2 :
7880
7881 - reqadd <string>
7882 - reqallow <search>
7883 - reqiallow <search>
7884 - reqdel <search>
7885 - reqidel <search>
7886 - reqdeny <search>
7887 - reqideny <search>
7888 - reqpass <search>
7889 - reqipass <search>
7890 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7891 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7892 - reqtarpit <search>
7893 - reqitarpit <search>
7894 - rspadd <string>
7895 - rspdel <search>
7896 - rspidel <search>
7897 - rspdeny <search>
7898 - rspideny <search>
7899 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7900 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7901
7902With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7903is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7904parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7905prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7906Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7907
7908 \t for a tab
7909 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7910 \n for a new line (LF)
7911 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7912 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7913 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7914 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7915 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7916
7917The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7918portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7919above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7920regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
79219 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7922is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7923
7924The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7925after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7926
7927Notes related to these keywords :
7928---------------------------------
7929 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7930 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7931 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7932
7933 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7934 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7935 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7936
7937 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7938 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7939 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7940 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7941 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7942
7943 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7944 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7945 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7946 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7947 useless headers before adding new ones.
7948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007949 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007950 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7951
7952 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7953 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7954 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7955
7956 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7957 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007958 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007959
7960
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010079617. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7962------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007963
7964The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7965content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7966from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7967simple :
7968
7969 - define test criteria with sets of values
7970 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7971
7972The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7973
7974In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7975
7976 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7977
7978This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7979Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7980and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7981an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7982of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7983
7984ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7985'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7986which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7987
7988There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7989performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7990
7991The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7992
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007993 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7994 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007995 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7996
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007997The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7998specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7999possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02008000multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
8001be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
8002needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
8003space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
8004match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
8005lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
8006duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008007to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02008008instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008009
8010 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8011
8012In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8013the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8014case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8015too.
8016
8017Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
8018a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
8019ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
8020
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008021Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008022
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008023 - integers or integer ranges
8024 - strings
8025 - regular expressions
8026 - IP addresses and networks
8027
8028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080297.1. Matching integers
8030----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008031
8032Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
8033that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
8034expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
8035may be omitted.
8036
8037For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8038unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8039representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8040
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008041As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8042two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8043instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8044ranges and operators.
8045
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008046For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008047operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8048Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8049of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008051Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008052
8053 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8054 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8055 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8056 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8057 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008059For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008060
8061 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8062
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008063This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8064
8065 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8066
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080687.2. Matching strings
8069---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008070
8071String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8072exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8073characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8074string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8075to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008076before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008077
8078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080797.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8080-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008081
8082Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8083they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8084possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8085passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8086the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008087the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8088match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008089
8090
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020080917.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008092----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008093
8094IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8095netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8096within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008097host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008098difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8099at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8100does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8101parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008102
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008103IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8104Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8105trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8106IPv6 patterns.
8107
8108HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8109following situations :
8110 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8111 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8112 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8113 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8114 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8115 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8116 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8117 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8118 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8119 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081227.5. Available matching criteria
8123--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081257.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
8126------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008127
8128A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
8129analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008130addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008132always_false
8133 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8134 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8135
8136always_true
8137 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8138 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8139
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008140avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008141avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008142 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
8143 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
8144 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
8145 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
8146 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
8147 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
8148 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
8149 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
8150 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
8151 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
8152 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008153
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008154be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008155be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008156 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8157 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8158 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8159 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8160 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008161
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008162be_id <integer>
8163 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
8164 backend it was called.
8165
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008166be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008167be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008168 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
8169 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8170 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8171 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8172 sucking of an online dictionary).
8173
8174 Example :
8175 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8176 backend dynamic
8177 mode http
8178 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8179 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008180
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008181srv_sess_rate(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
8182 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the server matches the
8183 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8184 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8185 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8186 latent requests from overloading servers).
8187
8188 Example :
8189 # Redirect to a separate back
8190 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8191 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8192 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8193
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008194connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008195connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008196 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008197 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008198 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8199
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008200 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8201 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008202
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008203 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008204 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
8205 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
8206 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8207 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
8208 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008209 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008210
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008211 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8212 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
8213 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
8214 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008216dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008217 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
8218 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008219
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008220dst_conn <integer>
8221 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
8222 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
8223 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8224 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8225 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8226 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
8227
8228dst_port <integer>
8229 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
8230 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
8231
8232fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008233fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008234 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8235 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8236 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8237 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8238 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8239 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8240 criteria.
8241
8242fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008243 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008244 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008245
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008246fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008247fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008248 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8249 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8250 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8251 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8252 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8253 the rate to go down below the limit.
8254
8255 Example :
8256 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8257 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8258 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8259 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8260 frontend mail
8261 bind :25
8262 mode tcp
8263 maxconn 100
8264 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8265 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8266 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8267 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008268
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008269nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008270nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008271 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8272 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8273 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8274 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8275 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008276
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008277queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008278queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008279 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8280 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8281 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8282 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8283 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8284 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8285 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8286
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008287sc1_bytes_in_rate <integer>
8288sc2_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008289 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8290 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8291 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8292
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008293sc1_bytes_out_rate <integer>
8294sc2_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008295 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8296 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8297 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8298
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008299sc1_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8300sc2_clr_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008301 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8302 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008303 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
8304 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8305 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008306
8307 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8308 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8309 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8310 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008311 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008312 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8313 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8314
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008315sc1_conn_cnt <integer>
8316sc2_conn_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008317 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8318 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8319
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008320sc1_conn_cur <integer>
8321sc2_conn_cur <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008322 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8323 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8324 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8325
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008326sc1_conn_rate <integer>
8327sc2_conn_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008328 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8329 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8330 See also src_conn_rate.
8331
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008332sc1_get_gpc0 <integer>
8333sc2_get_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008334 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8335 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8336
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008337sc1_http_err_cnt <integer>
8338sc2_http_err_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008339 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8340 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8341 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8342
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008343sc1_http_err_rate <integer>
8344sc2_http_err_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008345 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8346 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8347 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8348 src_http_err_rate.
8349
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008350sc1_http_req_cnt <integer>
8351sc2_http_req_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008352 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8353 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8354 src_http_req_cnt.
8355
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008356sc1_http_req_rate <integer>
8357sc2_http_req_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008358 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8359 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8360 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8361 src_http_req_rate.
8362
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008363sc1_inc_gpc0 <integer>
8364sc2_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008365 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008366 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
8367 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8368 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
8369 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008370
8371 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008372 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008373 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8374
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008375sc1_kbytes_in <integer>
8376sc2_kbytes_in <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008377 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8378 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8379 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8380 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8381
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008382sc1_kbytes_out <integer>
8383sc2_kbytes_out <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008384 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8385 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8386 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8387 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8388
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008389sc1_sess_cnt <integer>
8390sc2_sess_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008391 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8392 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8393 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8394 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008395 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008396 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8397
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008398sc1_sess_rate <integer>
8399sc2_sess_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008400 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8401 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8402 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8403 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8404 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008405 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008406
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008407sc1_trackers <integer>
8408sc2_trackers <integer>
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01008409 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8410 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8411 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc1_conn_cur in
8412 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
8413 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
8414 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking.
8415
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008416so_id <integer>
8417 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8418
8419src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008420 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8421 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8422 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008423
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008424src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008425src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008426 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8427 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8428 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008429 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008430
8431src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008432src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008433 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8434 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8435 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008436 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008437
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008438src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8439src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8440 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8441 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8442 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008443 entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a second ACL in
8444 an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008445
8446 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8447 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8448 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8449 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008450 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008451 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8452 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8453
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008454src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008455src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008456 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8457 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8458 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008459 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008460
8461src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008462src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008463 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8464 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8465 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008466 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008467
8468src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008469src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008470 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8471 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8472 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008473 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008474
8475src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008476src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008477 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8478 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8479 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008480 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008481
8482src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008483src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008484 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8485 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8486 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008487 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008488
8489src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008490src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008491 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8492 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8493 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8494 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008495 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008496
8497src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008498src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008499 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8500 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8501 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008502 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008503
8504src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008505src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008506 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8507 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8508 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8509 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008510 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008511
8512src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008513src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008514 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8515 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008516 stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not found, an entry
8517 is created and 1 is returned. This is typically used as a second ACL in an
8518 expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008519
8520 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008521 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008522 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008523
8524src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008525src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008526 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8527 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8528 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8529 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008530 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008531
8532src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008533src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008534 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8535 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8536 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8537 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008538 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008539
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008540src_port <integer>
8541 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008542
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008543src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008544src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008545 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8546 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8547 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8548 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008549 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008550
8551src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008552src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008553 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8554 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8555 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8556 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008557 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008558
8559src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008560src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008561 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008562 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8563 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008564 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8565 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8566 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008567 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008568
8569 Example :
8570 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8571 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8572 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8573 listen ssh
8574 bind :22
8575 mode tcp
8576 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008577 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008578 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8579 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8580
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008581srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008582 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8583 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8584 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8585 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8586
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008587srv_id <integer>
8588 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8589
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008590srv_is_up(<server>)
8591srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8592 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8593 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8594 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8595 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8596 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8597 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8598 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8599 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8600
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008601table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008602table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008603 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8604 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8605
8606table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008607table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008608 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8609 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8610 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020086137.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8614---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008615
8616A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8617during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008618through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8619keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008620
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008621rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8622 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8623 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8624 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008625 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8626 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8627 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008628
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008629req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008630 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008631 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8632 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8633 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8634 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8635 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8636 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8637
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008638req_proto_http
8639 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8640 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008641 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008642 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8643 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8644
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008645req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008646req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008647 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8648 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8649 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8650 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8651 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8652 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8653 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8654 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8655
8656req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008657req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008658 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8659 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8660 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8661 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8662 cookies.
8663
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008664req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8665 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8666 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8667 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008668 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8669 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8670 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008671
8672req_ssl_sni <string>
8673 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8674 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8675 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8676 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8677 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8678 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8679 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008680 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8681 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008682 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008683 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008684
8685 Examples :
8686 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8687 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8688 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8689 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8690 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8691
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008692req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8693 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8694 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8695 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8696 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8697 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8698 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008699 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8700 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008701 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008702 option.
8703
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008704ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8705 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8706 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8707 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8708 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8709 during this verification process.
8710
8711ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8712 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8713 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8714 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8715 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8716
8717ssl_c_err <integer>
8718 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8719 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8720 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8721 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8722
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008723ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8724ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8725 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8726 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8727 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8728 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8729 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8730 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8731 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8732 DN matches the specified string.
8733
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008734ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8735 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8736 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8737 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8738
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008739ssl_c_notafter <string>
8740 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8741 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8742 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8743
8744ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8745 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8746 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8747 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8748
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008749ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8750ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8751 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8752 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8753 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8754 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8755 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8756 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8757 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8758 DN matches the specified string.
8759
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008760ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8761 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8762 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8763 the value written in hexa.
8764
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008765ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8766 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8767 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8768 by the client matches the string.
8769
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008770ssl_c_used
8771 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
8772 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
8773
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008774ssl_c_verify <integer>
8775 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8776 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8777 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8778
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008779ssl_c_version <integer>
8780 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8781 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8782 the value.
8783
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008784ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8785ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8786 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8787 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8788 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8789 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8790 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8791 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8792 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8793 DN matches the specified string.
8794
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008795ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8796 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8797 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8798 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8799
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008800ssl_f_notafter <string>
8801 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8802 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8803 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8804
8805ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8806 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8807 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8808 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8809
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008810ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8811ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8812 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8813 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8814 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8815 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8816 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8817 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8818 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8819 DN matches the specified string.
8820
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008821ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8822 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8823 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8824 the value written in hexa.
8825
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008826ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8827 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8828 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8829 by the frontend matches the string.
8830
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008831ssl_f_version <integer>
8832 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8833 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8834 the value.
8835
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008836ssl_fc
8837 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8838 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8839 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8840
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008841ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8842 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8843 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8844
8845ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8846 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8847 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8848
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008849ssl_fc_has_crt
8850 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8851 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008852 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
8853 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
8854 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
8855 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008856
8857ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008858 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008859 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8860 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8861 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8862 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008863
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008864ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008865 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8866 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8867 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8868 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008869 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8870 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8871 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008872
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008873ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8874 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8875 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8876
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008877ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008878 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8879 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8880 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8881 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008882 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8883 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008884 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8885 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8886 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008887
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008888ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008889 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8890 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8891 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8892 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008893 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8894 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8895 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8896 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008897
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008898ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008899 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8900 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8901 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8902 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008903 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8904 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8905 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8906 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008907
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008908ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8909 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8910 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8911
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008912wait_end
8913 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8914 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8915 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8916 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8917 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8918 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8919 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8920 inspection.
8921
8922 Examples :
8923 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8924 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8925 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8926
8927 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8928 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8929 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8930 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8931 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8932 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8933 tcp-request content reject
8934
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089367.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8937--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008938
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008939A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008940application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8941read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8942than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8943
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008944base <string>
8945 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8946 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8947 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8948 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8949 See also "path" and "uri".
8950
8951base_beg <string>
8952 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8953 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8954 "path_beg".
8955
8956base_dir <string>
8957 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8958 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8959 "path_dir" instead.
8960
8961base_dom <string>
8962 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8963 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8964 instead.
8965
8966base_end <string>
8967 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8968 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8969
8970base_len <integer>
8971 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8972 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8973
8974base_reg <regex>
8975 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8976 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8977 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8978 and all "base_" criteria.
8979
8980base_sub <string>
8981 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8982 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8983 also "base_dir".
8984
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008985cook(<name>) <string>
8986 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8987 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8988 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8989 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8990 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8991 sent by the server.
8992
8993 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8994 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8995 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8996
8997 cook(profile) silver gold
8998
8999cook_beg(<name>) <string>
9000 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
9001 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9002 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9003
9004cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
9005 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
9006 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
9007 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
9008 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
9009 server.
9010
9011cook_dir(<name>) <string>
9012 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
9013 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
9014 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
9015 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
9016 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9017
9018cook_dom(<name>) <string>
9019 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
9020 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
9021 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9022 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9023
9024cook_end(<name>) <string>
9025 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
9026 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9027 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9028
9029cook_len(<name>) <integer>
9030 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
9031 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9032 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
9033 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
9034 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9035
9036cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
9037 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
9038 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
9039 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
9040 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9041 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9042
9043cook_sub(<name>) <string>
9044 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
9045 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9046 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9047
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009048cook_val(<name>) <integer>
9049 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
9050 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
9051 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
9052 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9053 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9054
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009055hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009056hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009057 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
9058 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
9059 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
9060 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009061 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
9062 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
9063 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9064 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
9065 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009066
9067 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009068 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009069 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
9070
9071 hdr(Connection) -i close
9072
9073hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009074hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009075 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
9076 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
9077 response headers sent by the server.
9078
9079hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009080hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009081 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
9082 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
9083 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
9084 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
9085 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
9086 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
9087 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9088
9089hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009090hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009091 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9092 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
9093 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
9094 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
9095 headers sent by the server.
9096
9097hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009098hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009099 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9100 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
9101 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
9102 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
9103 server.
9104
9105hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009106hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009107 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
9108 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
9109 response headers sent by the server.
9110
9111hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009112hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
9113 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9114 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
9115 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009116 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9117
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009118hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009119hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009120 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
9121 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9122 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
9123 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9124
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009125hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009126hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009127 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009128 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
9129 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
9130 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
9131 response headers sent by the server.
9132
9133hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009134hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009135 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
9136 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
9137 response headers sent by the server.
9138
9139hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009140hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009141 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
9142 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
9143 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
9144 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9145
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009146http_auth(<userlist>)
9147http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009148 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
9149 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
9150 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
9151 of specified groups.
9152
9153 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
9154
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02009155http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02009156 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
9157 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
9158 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
9159 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
9160
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009161method <string>
9162 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
9163 already check for most common methods.
9164
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009165path <string>
9166 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
9167 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
9168 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
9169
9170path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009171 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
9172 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009173
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009174path_dir <string>
9175 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9176 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9177 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9178 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
9179
9180path_dom <string>
9181 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9182 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
9183 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
9184
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009185path_end <string>
9186 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
9187 control file name extension.
9188
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009189path_len <integer>
9190 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
9191 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9192
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009193path_reg <regex>
9194 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9195 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
9196 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
9197
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009198path_sub <string>
9199 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9200 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
9201 "path_dir".
9202
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02009203payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
9204 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
9205 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
9206 strings.
9207
9208payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
9209 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9210 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9211 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
9212 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9213 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
9214
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009215req_ver <string>
9216 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
9217 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
9218
9219status <integer>
9220 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
9221 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
9222 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
9223
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009224url <string>
9225 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009226 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009227
9228url_beg <string>
9229 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009230 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
9231 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009232
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009233url_dir <string>
9234 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9235 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9236 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9237 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
9238
9239url_dom <string>
9240 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9241 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
9242 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
9243
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009244url_end <string>
9245 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9246 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009247
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009248url_ip <address>
9249 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9250 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9251 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009252
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009253url_len <integer>
9254 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9255 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9256
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009257url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009258 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9259 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009260 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009261 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009262
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009263url_reg <regex>
9264 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9265 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009266 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009267
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009268url_sub <string>
9269 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9270 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009271
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009272urlp(<name>) <string>
9273 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9274 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9275
9276 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9277 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9278
9279urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9280 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9281 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9282 protocol scheme.
9283
9284urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9285 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9286 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9287 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9288 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9289
9290urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9291 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9292 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9293 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9294 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9295
9296urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9297 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9298
9299urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009300 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9301 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009302
9303urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9304 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9305 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9306
9307urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9308 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9309 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9310 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9311 "urlp_" criteria.
9312
9313urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9314 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9315 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9316 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9317
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009318urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9319 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9320 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9321 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9322 negative data.
9323
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093257.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9326---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009328Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9329every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009330order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009332ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9333---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009334FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009335HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009336HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9337HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009338HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9339HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9340HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9341HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9342LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009343METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9344METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9345METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9346METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9347METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9348METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009349RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009350REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009351TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009352WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9353---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009354
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093567.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9357----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009359Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9360combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009362 - AND (implicit)
9363 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9364 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009366A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009368 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009370Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9371indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009373For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9374"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9375requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9376is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009378 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9379 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9380 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9381 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009383To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9384and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009386 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9387 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9388 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9389 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009391 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9392 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9393 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9394 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009395
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009396It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9397expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9398be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009399the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009400
9401 The following rule :
9402
9403 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9404 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9405
9406 Can also be written that way :
9407
9408 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9409
9410It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9411to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9412simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9413sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9414good use is the following :
9415
9416 With named ACLs :
9417
9418 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9419 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9420 monitor fail if site_dead
9421
9422 With anonymous ACLs :
9423
9424 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009426See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009427
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009428
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010094297.8. Pattern extraction
9430-----------------------
9431
9432The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9433response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9434for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9435
9436All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9437"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9438begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9439arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9440much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9441equivalent used in ACLs.
9442
9443The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9444
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009445 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9446 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9447 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9448 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9449 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9450 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9451 requested objects by host/path.
9452
Willy Tarreauab1f7b72012-12-09 13:38:54 +01009453 base32 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base"
9454 fetch method above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on
9455 high traffic sites without having to store all URLs. Instead a
9456 shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
9457 is an unsigned integer.
9458
Willy Tarreau4a550602012-12-09 14:53:32 +01009459 base32+src This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the
9460 src fetch below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a
9461 size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on the source address family.
9462 This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
9463
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009464 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009465 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9466 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9467 according to RFC 4291.
9468
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009469 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9470 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9471 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009472 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9473 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9474 according to RFC 4291.
9475
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009476 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9477 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9478 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9479 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9480 type integer and only works with such tables.
9481
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009482 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9483 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9484 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9485 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9486 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9487 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9488 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009489 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009490
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009491 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9492 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9493 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9494 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9495 wiser to use "url" instead.
9496
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009497 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009498 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9499 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9500 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9501 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009502
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009503 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009504 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9505 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9506 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9507 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9508 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9509 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9510 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9511 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009512
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009513 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9514 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9515 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9516 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9517
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009518 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9519 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9520
9521 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9522 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9523 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9524
9525 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9526 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9527
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009528 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9529 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9530 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9531 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009532 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9533 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009534 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9535 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9536 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9537 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9538 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9539
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009540 ssl_c_key_alg
9541 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9542 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9543 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9544
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009545 ssl_c_notafter
9546 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9547 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9548 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9549
9550 ssl_c_notbefore
9551 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9552 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9553 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9554
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009555 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9556 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9557 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9558 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009559 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9560 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009561 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9562 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9563 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9564 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9565 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9566
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009567 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9568 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9569 layer.
9570
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009571 ssl_c_sig_alg
9572 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9573 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9574 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9575
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009576 ssl_c_used
9577 Returns 1 if current SSL session use a client certificate,
9578 otherwise 0. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
9579
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009580 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9581 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9582 error is encountered.
9583
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009584 ssl_c_version
9585 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9586 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9587 layer.
9588
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009589 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9590 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9591 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9592 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009593 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9594 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009595 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9596 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9597 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9598 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9599 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9600
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009601 ssl_f_key_alg
9602 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9603 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9604 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9605
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009606 ssl_f_notafter
9607 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9608 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9609 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9610
9611 ssl_f_notbefore
9612 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9613 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9614 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9615
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009616 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9617 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9618 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9619 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009620 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9621 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009622 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9623 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9624 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9625 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9626 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9627
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009628 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9629 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9630 layer.
9631
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009632 ssl_f_sig_alg
9633 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9634 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9635 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9636
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009637 ssl_f_version
9638 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9639 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9640 layer.
9641
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009642 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9643 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9644 otherwise zero.
9645
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009646 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9647 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9648 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9649
9650 ssl_fc_cipher
9651 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9652 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9653
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009654 ssl_fc_has_crt
9655 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9656 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009657 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket,
9658 client certificate is not present in the current connection but
9659 may be retrieved from the cache or the ticket. So prefer
9660 "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if current SSL session uses
9661 a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009662
9663 ssl_fc_has_sni
9664 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009665 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9666 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009667 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009668 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009669
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009670 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009671 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9672 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9673 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9674 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009675 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009676
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009677 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009678 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9679 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009680
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009681 ssl_fc_session_id
9682 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9683 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9684 stick on a given client.
9685
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009686 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009687 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9688 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9689 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9690 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9691 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009692
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009693 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9694 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9695 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9696
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009697 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9698 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9699 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9700 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9701
9702 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9703 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9704 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9705 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9706 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9707 table for a given source address.
9708
9709 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9710 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9711
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009712 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009713 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009714 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9715 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9716 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9717 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9718 where cookies cannot be used.
9719
9720 Example :
9721 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9722 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9723 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9724 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009725
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009726 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009727 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9728 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9729 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9730 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009731
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009732 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9733 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9734 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9735 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9736 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9737 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9738 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009739
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009740 Example :
9741 listen tse-farm
9742 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9743 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9744 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9745 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9746 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9747 persist rdp-cookie
9748 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9749 # This is only useful makes sense if
9750 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9751 stick-table type string size 204800
9752 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9753 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9754 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009755
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009756 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9757 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009758
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009759 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009760 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009761 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9762 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9763 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9764 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9765 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9766 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009767
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009768 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009769
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009770 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009771 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9772 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9773 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9774
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009775 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9776 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9777 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9778 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9779 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009780
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009781 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009782
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009783
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009784The currently available list of transformations include :
9785
9786 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9787 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9788 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9789
9790 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9791 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9792 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9793
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009794 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009795 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9796 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9797 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9798 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9799
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098018. Logging
9802----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009804One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9805provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9806very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9807provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9808state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009809to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009810headers.
9811
9812In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9813about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9814send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9815
9816 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9817 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9818 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9819 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9820 at the termination.
9821
9822The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9823allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9824as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9825while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9826real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9827delay.
9828
9829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098308.1. Log levels
9831---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009832
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009833TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009834source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009835HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9836in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9837track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9838syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9839about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009840
9841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098428.2. Log formats
9843----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009844
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009845HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009846and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9847slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9848options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009849
9850 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9851 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9852 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9853 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9854 extents.
9855
9856 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9857 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9858 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9859 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9860 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9861
9862 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9863 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9864 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9865 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9866 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9867
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009868 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9869 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9870 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9871 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9872
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009873 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9874
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009875Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9876specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9877field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9878servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9879always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9880identifier.
9881
9882Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9883 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9884 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9885 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9886 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9887
9888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098898.2.1. Default log format
9890-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009891
9892This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9893as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9894format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9895
9896 Example :
9897 listen www
9898 mode http
9899 log global
9900 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9901
9902 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9903 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9904 (www/HTTP)
9905
9906 Field Format Extract from the example above
9907 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9908 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9909 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9910 4 'to' to
9911 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9912 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9913
9914Detailed fields description :
9915 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9916 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9917 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9918 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9919 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9920 and processed the connection.
9921 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9922
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009923In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9924"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9925connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9926
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009927It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9928will eventually disappear.
9929
9930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099318.2.2. TCP log format
9932---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009933
9934The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9935is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9936information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9937counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9938emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9939environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9940the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9941sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009942specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9943not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9944fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9945marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009946
9947 Example :
9948 frontend fnt
9949 mode tcp
9950 option tcplog
9951 log global
9952 default_backend bck
9953
9954 backend bck
9955 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9956
9957 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9958 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9959 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9960
9961 Field Format Extract from the example above
9962 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9963 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9964 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9965 4 frontend_name fnt
9966 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9967 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9968 7 bytes_read* 212
9969 8 termination_state --
9970 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9971 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9972
9973Detailed fields description :
9974 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009975 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9976 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9977 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9978 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9979 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009980
9981 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009982 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9983 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9984 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009985
9986 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9987 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9988 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9989 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9990
9991 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9992 and processed the connection.
9993
9994 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9995 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9996 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9997 applications.
9998
9999 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10000 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10001 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10002 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10003 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10004
10005 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10006 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10007 See "Timers" below for more details.
10008
10009 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10010 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10011 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10012 "Timers" below for more details.
10013
10014 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10015 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10016 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10017 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10018 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10019 details.
10020
10021 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10022 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10023 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10024 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10025 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10026
10027 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10028 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10029 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10030 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10031 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10032 for more details.
10033
10034 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010035 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010036 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10037 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10038 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010039 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010040
10041 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10042 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10043 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10044 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10045 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10046 caused by a denial of service attack.
10047
10048 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10049 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10050 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10051 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10052 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10053 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10054 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10055 denial of service attack.
10056
10057 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10058 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10059 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10060 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10061 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10062 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10063 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10064 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10065 be processed than on other servers.
10066
10067 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10068 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10069 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10070 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10071 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10072 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10073 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10074 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10075 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10076 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10077 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10078 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10079 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10080
10081 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10082 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10083 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10084 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10085 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10086 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10087 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10088 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10089
10090 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10091 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10092 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10093 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10094 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10095 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10096 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10097 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10098 occurs.
10099
10100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101018.2.3. HTTP log format
10102----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010103
10104The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10105is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10106the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10107are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10108emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10109generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10110"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10111which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010112frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10113is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010114
10115Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10116slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10117with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10118
10119 Example :
10120 frontend http-in
10121 mode http
10122 option httplog
10123 log global
10124 default_backend bck
10125
10126 backend static
10127 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10128
10129 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10130 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10131 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010132 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010133
10134 Field Format Extract from the example above
10135 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10136 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10137 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10138 4 frontend_name http-in
10139 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10140 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10141 7 status_code 200
10142 8 bytes_read* 2750
10143 9 captured_request_cookie -
10144 10 captured_response_cookie -
10145 11 termination_state ----
10146 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10147 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10148 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10149 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10150 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010151
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010152
10153Detailed fields description :
10154 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010155 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10156 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10157 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10158 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10159 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010160
10161 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010162 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10163 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10164 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010165
10166 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10167 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10168 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10169 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10170 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10171
10172 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10173 and processed the connection.
10174
10175 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10176 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10177 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10178
10179 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10180 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10181 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10182 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10183 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10184 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10185
10186 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10187 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10188 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10189 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10190 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10191 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10192
10193 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10194 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10195 See "Timers" below for more details.
10196
10197 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10198 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10199 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10200 below for more details.
10201
10202 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10203 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10204 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10205 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10206 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10207 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10208 for more details.
10209
10210 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10211 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10212 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10213 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10214 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10215 details.
10216
10217 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10218 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10219 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10220
10221 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10222 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10223 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10224 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10225 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10226 overflowing.
10227
10228 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10229 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10230 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10231 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10232 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10233 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10234 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10235 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10236
10237 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10238 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10239 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10240 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10241 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10242 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10243 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10244 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10245
10246 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10247 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10248 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10249 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10250 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10251 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10252 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10253
10254 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010255 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010256 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10257 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10258 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010259 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010260 system.
10261
10262 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10263 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10264 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10265 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10266 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10267 caused by a denial of service attack.
10268
10269 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10270 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10271 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10272 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10273 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10274 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10275 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10276 denial of service attack.
10277
10278 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10279 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10280 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10281 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10282 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10283 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10284 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10285 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10286 processed than on other servers.
10287
10288 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10289 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10290 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10291 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10292 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10293 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10294 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10295 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10296 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10297 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10298 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10299 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10300 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10301
10302 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10303 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10304 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10305 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10306 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10307 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10308 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10309 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10310
10311 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10312 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10313 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10314 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10315 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10316 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10317 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10318 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10319 occurs.
10320
10321 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10322 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10323 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10324 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10325 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10326 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10327 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10328 cookies" below for more details.
10329
10330 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10331 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10332 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10333 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10334 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10335 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10336 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10337 and cookies" below for more details.
10338
10339 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10340 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10341 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10342 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10343 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10344 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10345 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10346 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10347
10348
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200103498.2.4. Custom log format
10350------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010351
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010352The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010353mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010354
10355HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10356Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10357separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10358prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10359
10360Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10361variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10362string formats ("Q").
10363
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010364If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
10365as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.8). This it useful to add some
10366less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10367the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10368
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010369Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10370HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10371
10372Flags are :
10373 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010374 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010375
10376 Example:
10377
10378 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10379 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10380
10381At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10382
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010383 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10384 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010385
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010386the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010387
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010388 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010389 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010390 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010391
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010392and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10393
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010394 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010395 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10396
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010397Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10398
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010399 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010400 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010401 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10402 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10403 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010404 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10405 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10406 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010407 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010408 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010409 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010410 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010411 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010412 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010413 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10414 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010415 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010416 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10417 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010418 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010419 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10420 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010421 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10422 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10423 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010424 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010425 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10426 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010427 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010428 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10429 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10430 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010431 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010432 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10433 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10434 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10435 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010436 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010437 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010438 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010439 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010440 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010441 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010442 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10443 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10444 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010445 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010446 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10447 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010448 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010449 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010450 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010451 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010452
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010453 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010454
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010455
104568.2.5. Error log format
10457-----------------------
10458
10459When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10460protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10461By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10462"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10463will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10464logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10465
10466The format looks like this :
10467
10468 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
10469 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
10470 Connection error during SSL handshake
10471
10472 Field Format Extract from the example above
10473 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
10474 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
10475 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
10476 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
10477 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
10478
10479These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
10480failures.
10481
10482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104838.3. Advanced logging options
10484-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010485
10486Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10487just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10488options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10489for more information about their usage.
10490
10491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104928.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10493------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010494
10495It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10496haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10497commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10498monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10499ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10500
10501 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10502 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10503 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10504 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10505
10506 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10507 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10508 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10509 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10510 such as other load-balancers.
10511
10512 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10513 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10514 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10515
10516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105178.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10518----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010519
10520The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10521what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10522or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10523"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10524just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10525log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10526after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10527is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10528with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10529with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10530
10531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105328.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10533------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010534
10535Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10536for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10537"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10538retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10539raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10540a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10541file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10542you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10543"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10544
10545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105468.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10547--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010548
10549Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10550multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10551them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10552"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10553logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10554error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10555and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10556too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10557useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10558alternative.
10559
10560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105618.4. Timing events
10562------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010563
10564Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10565reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10566the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10567frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10568mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10569
10570 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10571 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10572 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10573 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10574 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10575
10576 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10577 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10578 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10579 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10580 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10581
10582 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10583 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10584 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10585 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10586 connection never established.
10587
10588 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10589 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10590 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10591 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10592 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10593 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10594 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10595 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10596 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10597 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10598 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10599
10600 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10601 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10602 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10603 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10604 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10605
10606 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10607
10608 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10609 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10610 negative.
10611
10612These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10613protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10614that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010615due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010616close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10617session has been aborted on timeout.
10618
10619Most common cases :
10620
10621 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10622 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10623 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10624 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10625 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10626 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10627 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10628 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10629 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010630 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10631 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10632 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010633
10634 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10635 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10636 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10637 of ms on remote networks.
10638
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010639 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10640 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10641 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010642
10643 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10644 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10645 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10646 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10647 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10648 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10649 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10650 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10651 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10652 to the server until another one is released.
10653
10654Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10655
10656 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10657 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10658 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10659
10660 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10661 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10662 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10663
10664 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10665 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10666 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10667 flags.
10668
10669 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10670 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10671 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10672 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10673 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10674 the client connection was maintained open.
10675
10676 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10677 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10678 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10679 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10680
10681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106828.5. Session state at disconnection
10683-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010684
10685TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10686"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
106872-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10688each of which has a special meaning :
10689
10690 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10691 session to terminate :
10692
10693 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10694
10695 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10696 server explicitly refused it.
10697
10698 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10699 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10700 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10701 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10702 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10703 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10704
10705 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10706 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10707 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10708 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10709 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10710
10711 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10712 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10713 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10714 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10715 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10716
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010717 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10718 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10719
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010720 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10721 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10722 backup connections when going up.
10723
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010724 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10725
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010726 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10727 send or receive data.
10728
10729 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10730 send or receive data.
10731
10732 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10733 with nothing left in the buffers.
10734
10735 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10736
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010737 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010738 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10739
10740 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10741 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10742 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10743 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10744 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10745
10746 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10747 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10748
10749 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10750 server (HTTP only).
10751
10752 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10753
10754 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10755 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10756 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10757
10758 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10759 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10760 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10761
10762 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10763
10764 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10765 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10766
10767 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10768 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10769 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10770
10771 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10772 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010773 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10774 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010775
10776 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10777 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10778 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10779 another server.
10780
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010781 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010782 server.
10783
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010784 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10785 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10786 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10787 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10788
10789 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10790 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10791 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10792 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10793
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010794 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10795 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10796 "use-server" rule).
10797
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010798 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10799
10800 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10801 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10802
10803 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10804
10805 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10806 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10807 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10808
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010809 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10810 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10811 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10812 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10813 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10814
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010815 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10816
10817 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10818 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10819
10820 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10821
10822 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10823
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010824The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10825was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010826helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10827starvation, attacks, etc...
10828
10829The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10830alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10831easier finding and understanding.
10832
10833 Flags Reason
10834
10835 -- Normal termination.
10836
10837 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10838 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10839 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10840 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10841
10842 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10843 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10844 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10845 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10846 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10847 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010848
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010849 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10850 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010851 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010852
10853 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10854 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10855 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10856
10857 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10858 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10859 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10860 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10861 the server takes too long to respond.
10862
10863 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10864 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10865 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10866 long a time to respond.
10867
10868 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10869 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10870 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10871 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10872 and the client.
10873
10874 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10875 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10876 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10877 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10878 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10879 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10880
10881 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10882 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010883 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10884 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10885 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10886 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010888 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010889 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10890 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10891 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10892 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10893 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10894
10895 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10896 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10897 503 or 504 here.
10898
10899 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10900 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10901 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10902 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10903 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10904
10905 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10906 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010907 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010908 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10909 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10910
10911 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10912 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10913 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10914 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10915 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10916 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10917 between haproxy and the server.
10918
10919 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10920 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10921 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10922 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10923 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10924 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10925 solution is to fix the application.
10926
10927 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10928 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10929 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10930 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10931 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10932 external attacks.
10933
10934 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10935 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010936 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010937 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10938 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10939
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010940 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10941 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10942 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10943 the client.
10944
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010945 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10946 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10947 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10948 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010949 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10950 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10951 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10952 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10953 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010954
10955 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10956 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10957 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10958 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10959
10960 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10961 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10962 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10963 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10964
10965 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10966 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10967 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10968 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10969
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010970The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10971persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10972important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10973re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10974
10975 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10976
10977 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10978 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10979 set on a GET request.
10980
10981 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10982 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010983 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010984 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10985
10986 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10987 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10988 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10989
10990 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10991 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10992 already got a cookie.
10993
10994 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10995 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10996 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10997 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10998 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10999
11000 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11001 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11002 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11003
11004 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11005 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11006 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11007
11008 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11009 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11010
11011 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11012 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11013 then advertised in the response.
11014
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110168.6. Non-printable characters
11017-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011018
11019In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11020consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11021converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11022prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11023being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11024escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11025is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11026'}' when logging headers.
11027
11028Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11029issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11030containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11031
11032Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11033the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11034performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11035
11036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110378.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11038---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011039
11040Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11041achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011042section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011043cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11044the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11045the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011046locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011047not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11048user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11049a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11050wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11051
11052 Examples :
11053 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11054 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11055
11056 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11057 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11058
11059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110608.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11061---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011062
11063Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11064proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11065the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11066server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11067
11068Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11069response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011070section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011071
11072It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011073time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11074appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011075are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11076and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11077follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11078request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11079in the logs.
11080
11081 Example :
11082 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11083 listen proxy-out
11084 mode http
11085 option httplog
11086 option logasap
11087 log global
11088 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11089
11090 # log the name of the virtual server
11091 capture request header Host len 20
11092
11093 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11094 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11095
11096 # log the beginning of the referrer
11097 capture request header Referer len 20
11098
11099 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11100 capture response header Server len 20
11101
11102 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11103 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11104
11105 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11106 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11107
11108 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11109 capture response header Via len 20
11110
11111 # log the URL location during a redirection
11112 capture response header Location len 20
11113
11114 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11115 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11116 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11117 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11118 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11119
11120 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11121 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11122 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11123 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011124 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011125
11126 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11127 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11128 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11129 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11130 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011131 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011132
11133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111348.9. Examples of logs
11135---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011136
11137These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11138them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11139reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11140
11141 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11142 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11143 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11144
11145 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11146 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11147
11148 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11149 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11150 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11151
11152 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11153 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11154
11155 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11156 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11157 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11158
11159 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011160 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011161 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11162 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11163
11164 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11165 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11166 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11167
11168 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11169 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011170 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011171 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11172 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11173 to return the 502 and not the server.
11174
11175 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011176 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011177
11178 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11179 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11180 Nothing was sent to any server.
11181
11182 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11183 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11184
11185 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11186 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11187 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11188 send a 408 return code to the client.
11189
11190 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11191 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11192
11193 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11194 5 seconds ("c----").
11195
11196 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11197 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011198 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011199
11200 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011201 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011202 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11203 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11204 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11205 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11206 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011207
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112099. Statistics and monitoring
11210----------------------------
11211
11212It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11213mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11214CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11215Unix socket.
11216
11217
112189.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011219---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011220
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011221The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11222page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11223
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011224 0. pxname: proxy name
11225 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11226 for server)
11227 2. qcur: current queued requests
11228 3. qmax: max queued requests
11229 4. scur: current sessions
11230 5. smax: max sessions
11231 6. slim: sessions limit
11232 7. stot: total sessions
11233 8. bin: bytes in
11234 9. bout: bytes out
11235 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011236 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011237 12. ereq: request errors
11238 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011239 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011240 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11241 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011242 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011243 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11244 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11245 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11246 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11247 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11248 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11249 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11250 25. qlimit: queue limit
11251 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11252 27. iid: unique proxy id
11253 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11254 29. throttle: warm up status
11255 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11256 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011257 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011258 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11259 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11260 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011261 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011262 UNK -> unknown
11263 INI -> initializing
11264 SOCKERR -> socket error
11265 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11266 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11267 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11268 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11269 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11270 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11271 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11272 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11273 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11274 disable-on-404
11275 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11276 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11277 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011278 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11279 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011280 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11281 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11282 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11283 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11284 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11285 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011286 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11287 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11288 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11289 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011290 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11291 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011292 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11293 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11294 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011295 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011296
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112989.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011299-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011300
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011301The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011302must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11303is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11304a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11305risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11306followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11307given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11308then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11309to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011310
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011311It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11312on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11313own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011314
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011315clear counters
11316 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11317 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11318 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11319 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11320 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11321
11322clear counters all
11323 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11324 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11325 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11326
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011327clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11328 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11329
11330 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11331 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11332 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11333 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11334 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11335 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11336
11337 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11338
11339 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11340 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11341 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11342 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11343 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11344 the ACLs :
11345
11346 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11347 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11348 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11349 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11350 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11351 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11352
11353 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011354 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11355 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011356
11357 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011358 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011359 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011360 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11361 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11362 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11363 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011364
11365 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11366
11367 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011368 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011369 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11370 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011371 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11372 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11373 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011374
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011375disable frontend <frontend>
11376 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11377 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11378 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11379 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11380 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11381 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11382 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11383 on the stats page.
11384
11385 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11386 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11387
11388 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11389 level "admin".
11390
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011391disable server <backend>/<server>
11392 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11393 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11394 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11395 during the maintenance.
11396
11397 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11398 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11399
11400 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011401 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011402
11403 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11404 level "admin".
11405
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011406enable frontend <frontend>
11407 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11408 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11409 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11410 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11411 which was disabled.
11412
11413 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11414 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11415
11416 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11417 level "admin".
11418
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011419enable server <backend>/<server>
11420 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11421 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11422
11423 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011424 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011425
11426 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11427 level "admin".
11428
11429get weight <backend>/<server>
11430 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11431 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11432 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11433 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11434 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011435 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011436
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011437help
11438 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11439 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011440
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011441prompt
11442 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11443 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11444 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11445 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11446 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11447 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11448 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11449 command.
11450
11451quit
11452 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011453
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011454set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011455 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11456 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11457 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11458 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11459 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011460 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11461 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11462
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011463set maxconn global <maxconn>
11464 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11465 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11466 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11467 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11468 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11469 setting.
11470
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011471set rate-limit connections global <value>
11472 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11473 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11474 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11475 is passed in number of connections per second.
11476
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011477set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11478 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11479 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011480 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11481 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011482
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011483set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11484 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11485 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11486 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11487 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11488 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11489
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011490set timeout cli <delay>
11491 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11492 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11493 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11494
11495set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11496 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11497 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090011498 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
11499 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
11500 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
11501 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
11502 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
11503 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
11504 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11505 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
11506 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
11507 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
11508 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
11509 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
11510 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011511
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011512show errors [<iid>]
11513 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11514 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011515 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11516 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11517 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011518
11519 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11520 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11521 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11522 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11523 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11524 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11525 are reported too.
11526
11527 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11528 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11529 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11530 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11531 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11532 code.
11533
11534 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11535 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11536 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11537 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11538 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11539 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11540 line.
11541
11542 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011543 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11544 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011545 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11546 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11547
11548 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11549 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11550 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11551 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11552 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11553 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11554 00204+ minal\r\n
11555 00211 \r\n
11556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011557 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011558 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11559 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11560 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11561 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11562 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11563 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011564
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011565show info
11566 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11567
11568show sess
11569 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011570 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11571 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11572
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011573show sess <id>
11574 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11575 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11576 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11577 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11578 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010011579 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
11580 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
11581 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011582
11583show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11584 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11585 possible to dump only selected items :
11586 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11587 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11588 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11589 for example:
11590 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11591 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11592 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11593
11594 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011595 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11596 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011597 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11598 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11599 Nbproc: 1
11600 Process_num: 1
11601 (...)
11602
11603 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11604 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11605 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11606 (...)
11607 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11608
11609 $
11610
11611 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11612 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11613 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11614 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011615 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011616
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011617show table
11618 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11619 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11620 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11621 entries currently in use.
11622
11623 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011624 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011625 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11626 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011627
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011628show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011629 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11630 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11631 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011632 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11633
11634 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11635 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11636 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11637 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11638 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11639
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011640 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11641 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11642 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11643 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11644 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11645 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11646
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011647
11648 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011649 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11650 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011651
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011652 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011653 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011654 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011655 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11656 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11657 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11658 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011659
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011660 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011661 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011662 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11663 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011664
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011665 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11666 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011667 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011668 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11669 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011670
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011671 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11672 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011673 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011674 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11675 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11676
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011677 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11678 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11679 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11680 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11681 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11682
11683 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11684 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11685 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011686 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11687 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011688 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11689 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011690
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011691shutdown frontend <frontend>
11692 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11693 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11694 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11695 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11696 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11697 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11698 once it is terminated.
11699
11700 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11701 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11702
11703 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11704 level "admin".
11705
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011706shutdown session <id>
11707 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11708 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11709 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11710 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11711 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11712 flag in the logs.
11713
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011714shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11715 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11716 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11717 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11718 'K' flag in the logs.
11719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011720/*
11721 * Local variables:
11722 * fill-column: 79
11723 * End:
11724 */